Mercurial > emacs
annotate doc/lispref/display.texi @ 106863:d6fc22738855
Reformat copyright line.
author | Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org> |
---|---|
date | Sat, 16 Jan 2010 06:58:42 -0500 |
parents | 1d1d5d9bd884 |
children | 2b8253dbde29 |
rev | line source |
---|---|
84060 | 1 @c -*-texinfo-*- |
2 @c This is part of the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. | |
3 @c Copyright (C) 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, | |
106815 | 4 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 |
103820
9e06f7e38c79
(Abstract Display): Merge in some menu descriptions from elisp.texi.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
103586
diff
changeset
|
5 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
84060 | 6 @c See the file elisp.texi for copying conditions. |
84116
0ba80d073e27
(setfilename): Go up one more level to ../../info.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
84060
diff
changeset
|
7 @setfilename ../../info/display |
84060 | 8 @node Display, System Interface, Processes, Top |
9 @chapter Emacs Display | |
10 | |
11 This chapter describes a number of features related to the display | |
12 that Emacs presents to the user. | |
13 | |
14 @menu | |
15 * Refresh Screen:: Clearing the screen and redrawing everything on it. | |
16 * Forcing Redisplay:: Forcing redisplay. | |
17 * Truncation:: Folding or wrapping long text lines. | |
18 * The Echo Area:: Displaying messages at the bottom of the screen. | |
19 * Warnings:: Displaying warning messages for the user. | |
20 * Invisible Text:: Hiding part of the buffer text. | |
21 * Selective Display:: Hiding part of the buffer text (the old way). | |
22 * Temporary Displays:: Displays that go away automatically. | |
23 * Overlays:: Use overlays to highlight parts of the buffer. | |
24 * Width:: How wide a character or string is on the screen. | |
25 * Line Height:: Controlling the height of lines. | |
26 * Faces:: A face defines a graphics style for text characters: | |
27 font, colors, etc. | |
28 * Fringes:: Controlling window fringes. | |
29 * Scroll Bars:: Controlling vertical scroll bars. | |
30 * Display Property:: Enabling special display features. | |
31 * Images:: Displaying images in Emacs buffers. | |
32 * Buttons:: Adding clickable buttons to Emacs buffers. | |
33 * Abstract Display:: Emacs' Widget for Object Collections. | |
34 * Blinking:: How Emacs shows the matching open parenthesis. | |
35 * Usual Display:: The usual conventions for displaying nonprinting chars. | |
36 * Display Tables:: How to specify other conventions. | |
37 * Beeping:: Audible signal to the user. | |
38 * Window Systems:: Which window system is being used. | |
39 @end menu | |
40 | |
41 @node Refresh Screen | |
42 @section Refreshing the Screen | |
43 | |
44 The function @code{redraw-frame} clears and redisplays the entire | |
45 contents of a given frame (@pxref{Frames}). This is useful if the | |
46 screen is corrupted. | |
47 | |
48 @c Emacs 19 feature | |
49 @defun redraw-frame frame | |
50 This function clears and redisplays frame @var{frame}. | |
51 @end defun | |
52 | |
53 Even more powerful is @code{redraw-display}: | |
54 | |
55 @deffn Command redraw-display | |
56 This function clears and redisplays all visible frames. | |
57 @end deffn | |
58 | |
87098 | 59 In Emacs, processing user input takes priority over redisplay. If |
60 you call these functions when input is available, they don't redisplay | |
61 immediately, but the requested redisplay does happen | |
62 eventually---after all the input has been processed. | |
84060 | 63 |
102950
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
64 On text-only terminals, suspending and resuming Emacs normally also |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
65 refreshes the screen. Some terminal emulators record separate |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
66 contents for display-oriented programs such as Emacs and for ordinary |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
67 sequential display. If you are using such a terminal, you might want |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
68 to inhibit the redisplay on resumption. |
84060 | 69 |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
70 @defopt no-redraw-on-reenter |
84060 | 71 @cindex suspend (cf. @code{no-redraw-on-reenter}) |
72 @cindex resume (cf. @code{no-redraw-on-reenter}) | |
73 This variable controls whether Emacs redraws the entire screen after it | |
74 has been suspended and resumed. Non-@code{nil} means there is no need | |
75 to redraw, @code{nil} means redrawing is needed. The default is @code{nil}. | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
76 @end defopt |
84060 | 77 |
78 @node Forcing Redisplay | |
79 @section Forcing Redisplay | |
80 @cindex forcing redisplay | |
81 | |
87098 | 82 Emacs normally tries to redisplay the screen whenever it waits for |
102950
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
83 input. With the following function, you can request an immediate |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
84 attempt to redisplay, in the middle of Lisp code, without actually |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
85 waiting for input. |
87098 | 86 |
87 @defun redisplay &optional force | |
88 This function tries immediately to redisplay, provided there are no | |
102950
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
89 pending input events. |
87098 | 90 |
91 If the optional argument @var{force} is non-@code{nil}, it does all | |
92 pending redisplay work even if input is available, with no | |
93 pre-emption. | |
94 | |
95 The function returns @code{t} if it actually tried to redisplay, and | |
96 @code{nil} otherwise. A value of @code{t} does not mean that | |
97 redisplay proceeded to completion; it could have been pre-empted by | |
98 newly arriving terminal input. | |
99 @end defun | |
100 | |
101 @code{redisplay} with no argument tries immediately to redisplay, | |
102 but has no effect on the usual rules for what parts of the screen to | |
103 redisplay. By contrast, the following function adds certain windows | |
104 to the pending redisplay work (as if their contents had completely | |
105 changed), but doesn't immediately try to do any redisplay work. | |
106 | |
107 @defun force-window-update &optional object | |
108 This function forces some or all windows to be updated on next | |
109 redisplay. If @var{object} is a window, it requires eventual | |
110 redisplay of that window. If @var{object} is a buffer or buffer name, | |
111 it requires eventual redisplay of all windows displaying that buffer. | |
112 If @var{object} is @code{nil} (or omitted), it requires eventual | |
113 redisplay of all windows. | |
114 @end defun | |
115 | |
116 @code{force-window-update} does not do a redisplay immediately. | |
117 (Emacs will do that when it waits for input.) Rather, its effect is | |
118 to put more work on the queue to be done by redisplay whenever there | |
119 is a chance. | |
120 | |
84060 | 121 Emacs redisplay normally stops if input arrives, and does not happen |
122 at all if input is available before it starts. Most of the time, this | |
123 is exactly what you want. However, you can prevent preemption by | |
124 binding @code{redisplay-dont-pause} to a non-@code{nil} value. | |
125 | |
87098 | 126 @defvar redisplay-dont-pause |
127 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, pending input does not | |
128 prevent or halt redisplay; redisplay occurs, and finishes, | |
129 regardless of whether input is available. | |
130 @end defvar | |
131 | |
84060 | 132 @defvar redisplay-preemption-period |
133 This variable specifies how many seconds Emacs waits between checks | |
134 for new input during redisplay. (The default is 0.1 seconds.) If | |
135 input has arrived when Emacs checks, it pre-empts redisplay and | |
136 processes the available input before trying again to redisplay. | |
137 | |
138 If this variable is @code{nil}, Emacs does not check for input during | |
139 redisplay, and redisplay cannot be preempted by input. | |
140 | |
141 This variable is only obeyed on graphical terminals. For | |
142 text terminals, see @ref{Terminal Output}. | |
143 @end defvar | |
144 | |
145 @node Truncation | |
146 @section Truncation | |
147 @cindex line wrapping | |
148 @cindex line truncation | |
149 @cindex continuation lines | |
150 @cindex @samp{$} in display | |
151 @cindex @samp{\} in display | |
152 | |
153 When a line of text extends beyond the right edge of a window, Emacs | |
154 can @dfn{continue} the line (make it ``wrap'' to the next screen | |
155 line), or @dfn{truncate} the line (limit it to one screen line). The | |
156 additional screen lines used to display a long text line are called | |
157 @dfn{continuation} lines. Continuation is not the same as filling; | |
158 continuation happens on the screen only, not in the buffer contents, | |
159 and it breaks a line precisely at the right margin, not at a word | |
160 boundary. @xref{Filling}. | |
161 | |
162 On a graphical display, tiny arrow images in the window fringes | |
163 indicate truncated and continued lines (@pxref{Fringes}). On a text | |
164 terminal, a @samp{$} in the rightmost column of the window indicates | |
165 truncation; a @samp{\} on the rightmost column indicates a line that | |
166 ``wraps.'' (The display table can specify alternate characters to use | |
167 for this; @pxref{Display Tables}). | |
168 | |
169 @defopt truncate-lines | |
102950
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
170 If this buffer-local variable is non-@code{nil}, lines that extend |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
171 beyond the right edge of the window are truncated; otherwise, they are |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
172 continued. As a special exception, the variable |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
173 @code{truncate-partial-width-windows} takes precedence in |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
174 @dfn{partial-width} windows (i.e., windows that do not occupy the |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
175 entire frame width). |
84060 | 176 @end defopt |
177 | |
178 @defopt truncate-partial-width-windows | |
102950
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
179 This variable controls line truncation in @dfn{partial-width} windows. |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
180 A partial-width window is one that does not occupy the entire frame |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
181 width (@pxref{Splitting Windows}). If the value is @code{nil}, line |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
182 truncation is determined by the variable @code{truncate-lines} (see |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
183 above). If the value is an integer @var{n}, lines are truncated if |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
184 the partial-width window has fewer than @var{n} columns, regardless of |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
185 the value of @code{truncate-lines}; if the partial-width window has |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
186 @var{n} or more columns, line truncation is determined by |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
187 @code{truncate-lines}. For any other non-@code{nil} value, lines are |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
188 truncated in every partial-width window, regardless of the value of |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
189 @code{truncate-lines}. |
84060 | 190 @end defopt |
191 | |
192 When horizontal scrolling (@pxref{Horizontal Scrolling}) is in use in | |
193 a window, that forces truncation. | |
194 | |
96470
2af6e85f13d5
Implement display-time wrap/line-prefix feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
96396
diff
changeset
|
195 @defvar wrap-prefix |
102950
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
196 If this buffer-local variable is non-@code{nil}, it defines a |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
197 ``prefix'' that is prepended to every continuation line at |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
198 display-time. (If lines are truncated, the wrap-prefix is never |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
199 used.) It may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; the value is |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
200 interpreted in the same way as a @code{display} text property. |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
201 @xref{Display Property}. |
102950
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
202 |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
203 A wrap-prefix may also be specified for regions of text, using the |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
204 @code{wrap-prefix} text or overlay property. This takes precedence |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
205 over the @code{wrap-prefix} variable. @xref{Special Properties}. |
96470
2af6e85f13d5
Implement display-time wrap/line-prefix feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
96396
diff
changeset
|
206 @end defvar |
2af6e85f13d5
Implement display-time wrap/line-prefix feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
96396
diff
changeset
|
207 |
2af6e85f13d5
Implement display-time wrap/line-prefix feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
96396
diff
changeset
|
208 @defvar line-prefix |
102950
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
209 If this buffer-local variable is non-@code{nil}, it defines a |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
210 ``prefix'' that is prepended to every non-continuation line at |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
211 display-time. It may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; the |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
212 value is interpreted in the same way as a @code{display} text |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
213 property. @xref{Display Property}. |
96470
2af6e85f13d5
Implement display-time wrap/line-prefix feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
96396
diff
changeset
|
214 |
2af6e85f13d5
Implement display-time wrap/line-prefix feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
96396
diff
changeset
|
215 A line-prefix may also be specified for regions of text using the |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
216 @code{line-prefix} text or overlay property. This takes precedence |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
217 over the @code{line-prefix} variable. @xref{Special Properties}. |
96470
2af6e85f13d5
Implement display-time wrap/line-prefix feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
96396
diff
changeset
|
218 @end defvar |
2af6e85f13d5
Implement display-time wrap/line-prefix feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
96396
diff
changeset
|
219 |
84060 | 220 If your buffer contains @emph{very} long lines, and you use |
102950
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
221 continuation to display them, computing the continuation lines can |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
222 make Emacs redisplay slow. The column computation and indentation |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
223 functions also become slow. Then you might find it advisable to set |
84060 | 224 @code{cache-long-line-scans} to @code{t}. |
225 | |
226 @defvar cache-long-line-scans | |
227 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, various indentation and motion | |
228 functions, and Emacs redisplay, cache the results of scanning the | |
229 buffer, and consult the cache to avoid rescanning regions of the buffer | |
230 unless they are modified. | |
231 | |
232 Turning on the cache slows down processing of short lines somewhat. | |
233 | |
234 This variable is automatically buffer-local in every buffer. | |
235 @end defvar | |
236 | |
237 @node The Echo Area | |
238 @section The Echo Area | |
239 @cindex error display | |
240 @cindex echo area | |
241 | |
242 The @dfn{echo area} is used for displaying error messages | |
243 (@pxref{Errors}), for messages made with the @code{message} primitive, | |
244 and for echoing keystrokes. It is not the same as the minibuffer, | |
245 despite the fact that the minibuffer appears (when active) in the same | |
246 place on the screen as the echo area. The @cite{GNU Emacs Manual} | |
247 specifies the rules for resolving conflicts between the echo area and | |
248 the minibuffer for use of that screen space (@pxref{Minibuffer,, The | |
249 Minibuffer, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}). | |
250 | |
251 You can write output in the echo area by using the Lisp printing | |
252 functions with @code{t} as the stream (@pxref{Output Functions}), or | |
253 explicitly. | |
254 | |
255 @menu | |
256 * Displaying Messages:: Explicitly displaying text in the echo area. | |
257 * Progress:: Informing user about progress of a long operation. | |
258 * Logging Messages:: Echo area messages are logged for the user. | |
259 * Echo Area Customization:: Controlling the echo area. | |
260 @end menu | |
261 | |
262 @node Displaying Messages | |
263 @subsection Displaying Messages in the Echo Area | |
264 @cindex display message in echo area | |
265 | |
266 This section describes the functions for explicitly producing echo | |
267 area messages. Many other Emacs features display messages there, too. | |
268 | |
269 @defun message format-string &rest arguments | |
270 This function displays a message in the echo area. The argument | |
271 @var{format-string} is similar to a C language @code{printf} format | |
272 string. See @code{format} in @ref{Formatting Strings}, for the details | |
273 on the conversion specifications. @code{message} returns the | |
274 constructed string. | |
275 | |
276 In batch mode, @code{message} prints the message text on the standard | |
277 error stream, followed by a newline. | |
278 | |
279 If @var{format-string}, or strings among the @var{arguments}, have | |
280 @code{face} text properties, these affect the way the message is displayed. | |
281 | |
282 @c Emacs 19 feature | |
283 If @var{format-string} is @code{nil} or the empty string, | |
284 @code{message} clears the echo area; if the echo area has been | |
285 expanded automatically, this brings it back to its normal size. | |
286 If the minibuffer is active, this brings the minibuffer contents back | |
287 onto the screen immediately. | |
288 | |
289 @example | |
290 @group | |
291 (message "Minibuffer depth is %d." | |
292 (minibuffer-depth)) | |
293 @print{} Minibuffer depth is 0. | |
294 @result{} "Minibuffer depth is 0." | |
295 @end group | |
296 | |
297 @group | |
298 ---------- Echo Area ---------- | |
299 Minibuffer depth is 0. | |
300 ---------- Echo Area ---------- | |
301 @end group | |
302 @end example | |
303 | |
304 To automatically display a message in the echo area or in a pop-buffer, | |
305 depending on its size, use @code{display-message-or-buffer} (see below). | |
306 @end defun | |
307 | |
308 @defmac with-temp-message message &rest body | |
309 This construct displays a message in the echo area temporarily, during | |
310 the execution of @var{body}. It displays @var{message}, executes | |
311 @var{body}, then returns the value of the last body form while restoring | |
312 the previous echo area contents. | |
313 @end defmac | |
314 | |
315 @defun message-or-box format-string &rest arguments | |
316 This function displays a message like @code{message}, but may display it | |
317 in a dialog box instead of the echo area. If this function is called in | |
318 a command that was invoked using the mouse---more precisely, if | |
319 @code{last-nonmenu-event} (@pxref{Command Loop Info}) is either | |
320 @code{nil} or a list---then it uses a dialog box or pop-up menu to | |
321 display the message. Otherwise, it uses the echo area. (This is the | |
322 same criterion that @code{y-or-n-p} uses to make a similar decision; see | |
323 @ref{Yes-or-No Queries}.) | |
324 | |
325 You can force use of the mouse or of the echo area by binding | |
326 @code{last-nonmenu-event} to a suitable value around the call. | |
327 @end defun | |
328 | |
329 @defun message-box format-string &rest arguments | |
330 @anchor{message-box} | |
331 This function displays a message like @code{message}, but uses a dialog | |
332 box (or a pop-up menu) whenever that is possible. If it is impossible | |
333 to use a dialog box or pop-up menu, because the terminal does not | |
334 support them, then @code{message-box} uses the echo area, like | |
335 @code{message}. | |
336 @end defun | |
337 | |
338 @defun display-message-or-buffer message &optional buffer-name not-this-window frame | |
339 This function displays the message @var{message}, which may be either a | |
340 string or a buffer. If it is shorter than the maximum height of the | |
341 echo area, as defined by @code{max-mini-window-height}, it is displayed | |
342 in the echo area, using @code{message}. Otherwise, | |
343 @code{display-buffer} is used to show it in a pop-up buffer. | |
344 | |
345 Returns either the string shown in the echo area, or when a pop-up | |
346 buffer is used, the window used to display it. | |
347 | |
348 If @var{message} is a string, then the optional argument | |
349 @var{buffer-name} is the name of the buffer used to display it when a | |
350 pop-up buffer is used, defaulting to @samp{*Message*}. In the case | |
351 where @var{message} is a string and displayed in the echo area, it is | |
352 not specified whether the contents are inserted into the buffer anyway. | |
353 | |
354 The optional arguments @var{not-this-window} and @var{frame} are as for | |
355 @code{display-buffer}, and only used if a buffer is displayed. | |
356 @end defun | |
357 | |
358 @defun current-message | |
359 This function returns the message currently being displayed in the | |
360 echo area, or @code{nil} if there is none. | |
361 @end defun | |
362 | |
363 @node Progress | |
364 @subsection Reporting Operation Progress | |
365 @cindex progress reporting | |
366 | |
367 When an operation can take a while to finish, you should inform the | |
368 user about the progress it makes. This way the user can estimate | |
369 remaining time and clearly see that Emacs is busy working, not hung. | |
370 | |
371 Functions listed in this section provide simple and efficient way of | |
372 reporting operation progress. Here is a working example that does | |
373 nothing useful: | |
374 | |
375 @smallexample | |
376 (let ((progress-reporter | |
377 (make-progress-reporter "Collecting mana for Emacs..." | |
378 0 500))) | |
379 (dotimes (k 500) | |
380 (sit-for 0.01) | |
381 (progress-reporter-update progress-reporter k)) | |
382 (progress-reporter-done progress-reporter)) | |
383 @end smallexample | |
384 | |
385 @defun make-progress-reporter message min-value max-value &optional current-value min-change min-time | |
386 This function creates and returns a @dfn{progress reporter}---an | |
387 object you will use as an argument for all other functions listed | |
388 here. The idea is to precompute as much data as possible to make | |
389 progress reporting very fast. | |
390 | |
391 When this progress reporter is subsequently used, it will display | |
392 @var{message} in the echo area, followed by progress percentage. | |
393 @var{message} is treated as a simple string. If you need it to depend | |
394 on a filename, for instance, use @code{format} before calling this | |
395 function. | |
396 | |
397 @var{min-value} and @var{max-value} arguments stand for starting and | |
398 final states of your operation. For instance, if you scan a buffer, | |
399 they should be the results of @code{point-min} and @code{point-max} | |
400 correspondingly. It is required that @var{max-value} is greater than | |
401 @var{min-value}. If you create progress reporter when some part of | |
402 the operation has already been completed, then specify | |
403 @var{current-value} argument. But normally you should omit it or set | |
404 it to @code{nil}---it will default to @var{min-value} then. | |
405 | |
406 Remaining arguments control the rate of echo area updates. Progress | |
407 reporter will wait for at least @var{min-change} more percents of the | |
408 operation to be completed before printing next message. | |
409 @var{min-time} specifies the minimum time in seconds to pass between | |
410 successive prints. It can be fractional. Depending on Emacs and | |
411 system capabilities, progress reporter may or may not respect this | |
412 last argument or do it with varying precision. Default value for | |
413 @var{min-change} is 1 (one percent), for @var{min-time}---0.2 | |
414 (seconds.) | |
415 | |
416 This function calls @code{progress-reporter-update}, so the first | |
417 message is printed immediately. | |
418 @end defun | |
419 | |
420 @defun progress-reporter-update reporter value | |
421 This function does the main work of reporting progress of your | |
422 operation. It displays the message of @var{reporter}, followed by | |
423 progress percentage determined by @var{value}. If percentage is zero, | |
424 or close enough according to the @var{min-change} and @var{min-time} | |
425 arguments, then it is omitted from the output. | |
426 | |
427 @var{reporter} must be the result of a call to | |
428 @code{make-progress-reporter}. @var{value} specifies the current | |
429 state of your operation and must be between @var{min-value} and | |
430 @var{max-value} (inclusive) as passed to | |
431 @code{make-progress-reporter}. For instance, if you scan a buffer, | |
432 then @var{value} should be the result of a call to @code{point}. | |
433 | |
434 This function respects @var{min-change} and @var{min-time} as passed | |
435 to @code{make-progress-reporter} and so does not output new messages | |
436 on every invocation. It is thus very fast and normally you should not | |
437 try to reduce the number of calls to it: resulting overhead will most | |
438 likely negate your effort. | |
439 @end defun | |
440 | |
441 @defun progress-reporter-force-update reporter value &optional new-message | |
442 This function is similar to @code{progress-reporter-update} except | |
443 that it prints a message in the echo area unconditionally. | |
444 | |
445 The first two arguments have the same meaning as for | |
446 @code{progress-reporter-update}. Optional @var{new-message} allows | |
447 you to change the message of the @var{reporter}. Since this functions | |
448 always updates the echo area, such a change will be immediately | |
449 presented to the user. | |
450 @end defun | |
451 | |
452 @defun progress-reporter-done reporter | |
453 This function should be called when the operation is finished. It | |
454 prints the message of @var{reporter} followed by word ``done'' in the | |
455 echo area. | |
456 | |
457 You should always call this function and not hope for | |
458 @code{progress-reporter-update} to print ``100%.'' Firstly, it may | |
459 never print it, there are many good reasons for this not to happen. | |
460 Secondly, ``done'' is more explicit. | |
461 @end defun | |
462 | |
463 @defmac dotimes-with-progress-reporter (var count [result]) message body@dots{} | |
464 This is a convenience macro that works the same way as @code{dotimes} | |
465 does, but also reports loop progress using the functions described | |
466 above. It allows you to save some typing. | |
467 | |
468 You can rewrite the example in the beginning of this node using | |
469 this macro this way: | |
470 | |
471 @example | |
472 (dotimes-with-progress-reporter | |
473 (k 500) | |
474 "Collecting some mana for Emacs..." | |
475 (sit-for 0.01)) | |
476 @end example | |
477 @end defmac | |
478 | |
479 @node Logging Messages | |
480 @subsection Logging Messages in @samp{*Messages*} | |
481 @cindex logging echo-area messages | |
482 | |
483 Almost all the messages displayed in the echo area are also recorded | |
484 in the @samp{*Messages*} buffer so that the user can refer back to | |
485 them. This includes all the messages that are output with | |
486 @code{message}. | |
487 | |
488 @defopt message-log-max | |
489 This variable specifies how many lines to keep in the @samp{*Messages*} | |
490 buffer. The value @code{t} means there is no limit on how many lines to | |
491 keep. The value @code{nil} disables message logging entirely. Here's | |
492 how to display a message and prevent it from being logged: | |
493 | |
494 @example | |
495 (let (message-log-max) | |
496 (message @dots{})) | |
497 @end example | |
498 @end defopt | |
499 | |
500 To make @samp{*Messages*} more convenient for the user, the logging | |
501 facility combines successive identical messages. It also combines | |
502 successive related messages for the sake of two cases: question | |
503 followed by answer, and a series of progress messages. | |
504 | |
505 A ``question followed by an answer'' means two messages like the | |
506 ones produced by @code{y-or-n-p}: the first is @samp{@var{question}}, | |
507 and the second is @samp{@var{question}...@var{answer}}. The first | |
508 message conveys no additional information beyond what's in the second, | |
509 so logging the second message discards the first from the log. | |
510 | |
511 A ``series of progress messages'' means successive messages like | |
512 those produced by @code{make-progress-reporter}. They have the form | |
513 @samp{@var{base}...@var{how-far}}, where @var{base} is the same each | |
514 time, while @var{how-far} varies. Logging each message in the series | |
515 discards the previous one, provided they are consecutive. | |
516 | |
517 The functions @code{make-progress-reporter} and @code{y-or-n-p} | |
518 don't have to do anything special to activate the message log | |
519 combination feature. It operates whenever two consecutive messages | |
520 are logged that share a common prefix ending in @samp{...}. | |
521 | |
522 @node Echo Area Customization | |
523 @subsection Echo Area Customization | |
524 | |
525 These variables control details of how the echo area works. | |
526 | |
527 @defvar cursor-in-echo-area | |
528 This variable controls where the cursor appears when a message is | |
529 displayed in the echo area. If it is non-@code{nil}, then the cursor | |
530 appears at the end of the message. Otherwise, the cursor appears at | |
531 point---not in the echo area at all. | |
532 | |
533 The value is normally @code{nil}; Lisp programs bind it to @code{t} | |
534 for brief periods of time. | |
535 @end defvar | |
536 | |
537 @defvar echo-area-clear-hook | |
538 This normal hook is run whenever the echo area is cleared---either by | |
539 @code{(message nil)} or for any other reason. | |
540 @end defvar | |
541 | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
542 @defopt echo-keystrokes |
84060 | 543 This variable determines how much time should elapse before command |
544 characters echo. Its value must be an integer or floating point number, | |
545 which specifies the | |
546 number of seconds to wait before echoing. If the user types a prefix | |
547 key (such as @kbd{C-x}) and then delays this many seconds before | |
548 continuing, the prefix key is echoed in the echo area. (Once echoing | |
549 begins in a key sequence, all subsequent characters in the same key | |
550 sequence are echoed immediately.) | |
551 | |
552 If the value is zero, then command input is not echoed. | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
553 @end defopt |
84060 | 554 |
555 @defvar message-truncate-lines | |
556 Normally, displaying a long message resizes the echo area to display | |
557 the entire message. But if the variable @code{message-truncate-lines} | |
558 is non-@code{nil}, the echo area does not resize, and the message is | |
559 truncated to fit it, as in Emacs 20 and before. | |
560 @end defvar | |
561 | |
562 The variable @code{max-mini-window-height}, which specifies the | |
563 maximum height for resizing minibuffer windows, also applies to the | |
564 echo area (which is really a special use of the minibuffer window. | |
98185
c9d121831418
* display.texi (Echo Area Customization): Fix typo.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
97725
diff
changeset
|
565 @xref{Minibuffer Misc}.). |
84060 | 566 |
567 @node Warnings | |
568 @section Reporting Warnings | |
569 @cindex warnings | |
570 | |
571 @dfn{Warnings} are a facility for a program to inform the user of a | |
572 possible problem, but continue running. | |
573 | |
574 @menu | |
575 * Warning Basics:: Warnings concepts and functions to report them. | |
576 * Warning Variables:: Variables programs bind to customize their warnings. | |
577 * Warning Options:: Variables users set to control display of warnings. | |
578 @end menu | |
579 | |
580 @node Warning Basics | |
581 @subsection Warning Basics | |
582 @cindex severity level | |
583 | |
584 Every warning has a textual message, which explains the problem for | |
585 the user, and a @dfn{severity level} which is a symbol. Here are the | |
586 possible severity levels, in order of decreasing severity, and their | |
587 meanings: | |
588 | |
589 @table @code | |
590 @item :emergency | |
591 A problem that will seriously impair Emacs operation soon | |
592 if you do not attend to it promptly. | |
593 @item :error | |
594 A report of data or circumstances that are inherently wrong. | |
595 @item :warning | |
596 A report of data or circumstances that are not inherently wrong, but | |
597 raise suspicion of a possible problem. | |
598 @item :debug | |
599 A report of information that may be useful if you are debugging. | |
600 @end table | |
601 | |
602 When your program encounters invalid input data, it can either | |
603 signal a Lisp error by calling @code{error} or @code{signal} or report | |
604 a warning with severity @code{:error}. Signaling a Lisp error is the | |
605 easiest thing to do, but it means the program cannot continue | |
606 processing. If you want to take the trouble to implement a way to | |
607 continue processing despite the bad data, then reporting a warning of | |
608 severity @code{:error} is the right way to inform the user of the | |
609 problem. For instance, the Emacs Lisp byte compiler can report an | |
610 error that way and continue compiling other functions. (If the | |
611 program signals a Lisp error and then handles it with | |
612 @code{condition-case}, the user won't see the error message; it could | |
613 show the message to the user by reporting it as a warning.) | |
614 | |
615 @cindex warning type | |
616 Each warning has a @dfn{warning type} to classify it. The type is a | |
617 list of symbols. The first symbol should be the custom group that you | |
618 use for the program's user options. For example, byte compiler | |
619 warnings use the warning type @code{(bytecomp)}. You can also | |
620 subcategorize the warnings, if you wish, by using more symbols in the | |
621 list. | |
622 | |
623 @defun display-warning type message &optional level buffer-name | |
624 This function reports a warning, using @var{message} as the message | |
625 and @var{type} as the warning type. @var{level} should be the | |
626 severity level, with @code{:warning} being the default. | |
627 | |
628 @var{buffer-name}, if non-@code{nil}, specifies the name of the buffer | |
629 for logging the warning. By default, it is @samp{*Warnings*}. | |
630 @end defun | |
631 | |
632 @defun lwarn type level message &rest args | |
633 This function reports a warning using the value of @code{(format | |
634 @var{message} @var{args}...)} as the message. In other respects it is | |
635 equivalent to @code{display-warning}. | |
636 @end defun | |
637 | |
638 @defun warn message &rest args | |
639 This function reports a warning using the value of @code{(format | |
640 @var{message} @var{args}...)} as the message, @code{(emacs)} as the | |
641 type, and @code{:warning} as the severity level. It exists for | |
642 compatibility only; we recommend not using it, because you should | |
643 specify a specific warning type. | |
644 @end defun | |
645 | |
646 @node Warning Variables | |
647 @subsection Warning Variables | |
648 | |
649 Programs can customize how their warnings appear by binding | |
650 the variables described in this section. | |
651 | |
652 @defvar warning-levels | |
653 This list defines the meaning and severity order of the warning | |
654 severity levels. Each element defines one severity level, | |
655 and they are arranged in order of decreasing severity. | |
656 | |
657 Each element has the form @code{(@var{level} @var{string} | |
658 @var{function})}, where @var{level} is the severity level it defines. | |
659 @var{string} specifies the textual description of this level. | |
660 @var{string} should use @samp{%s} to specify where to put the warning | |
661 type information, or it can omit the @samp{%s} so as not to include | |
662 that information. | |
663 | |
664 The optional @var{function}, if non-@code{nil}, is a function to call | |
665 with no arguments, to get the user's attention. | |
666 | |
667 Normally you should not change the value of this variable. | |
668 @end defvar | |
669 | |
670 @defvar warning-prefix-function | |
671 If non-@code{nil}, the value is a function to generate prefix text for | |
672 warnings. Programs can bind the variable to a suitable function. | |
673 @code{display-warning} calls this function with the warnings buffer | |
674 current, and the function can insert text in it. That text becomes | |
675 the beginning of the warning message. | |
676 | |
677 The function is called with two arguments, the severity level and its | |
678 entry in @code{warning-levels}. It should return a list to use as the | |
679 entry (this value need not be an actual member of | |
680 @code{warning-levels}). By constructing this value, the function can | |
681 change the severity of the warning, or specify different handling for | |
682 a given severity level. | |
683 | |
684 If the variable's value is @code{nil} then there is no function | |
685 to call. | |
686 @end defvar | |
687 | |
688 @defvar warning-series | |
689 Programs can bind this variable to @code{t} to say that the next | |
690 warning should begin a series. When several warnings form a series, | |
691 that means to leave point on the first warning of the series, rather | |
692 than keep moving it for each warning so that it appears on the last one. | |
693 The series ends when the local binding is unbound and | |
694 @code{warning-series} becomes @code{nil} again. | |
695 | |
696 The value can also be a symbol with a function definition. That is | |
697 equivalent to @code{t}, except that the next warning will also call | |
698 the function with no arguments with the warnings buffer current. The | |
699 function can insert text which will serve as a header for the series | |
700 of warnings. | |
701 | |
702 Once a series has begun, the value is a marker which points to the | |
703 buffer position in the warnings buffer of the start of the series. | |
704 | |
705 The variable's normal value is @code{nil}, which means to handle | |
706 each warning separately. | |
707 @end defvar | |
708 | |
709 @defvar warning-fill-prefix | |
710 When this variable is non-@code{nil}, it specifies a fill prefix to | |
711 use for filling each warning's text. | |
712 @end defvar | |
713 | |
714 @defvar warning-type-format | |
715 This variable specifies the format for displaying the warning type | |
716 in the warning message. The result of formatting the type this way | |
717 gets included in the message under the control of the string in the | |
718 entry in @code{warning-levels}. The default value is @code{" (%s)"}. | |
719 If you bind it to @code{""} then the warning type won't appear at | |
720 all. | |
721 @end defvar | |
722 | |
723 @node Warning Options | |
724 @subsection Warning Options | |
725 | |
726 These variables are used by users to control what happens | |
727 when a Lisp program reports a warning. | |
728 | |
729 @defopt warning-minimum-level | |
730 This user option specifies the minimum severity level that should be | |
731 shown immediately to the user. The default is @code{:warning}, which | |
732 means to immediately display all warnings except @code{:debug} | |
733 warnings. | |
734 @end defopt | |
735 | |
736 @defopt warning-minimum-log-level | |
737 This user option specifies the minimum severity level that should be | |
738 logged in the warnings buffer. The default is @code{:warning}, which | |
739 means to log all warnings except @code{:debug} warnings. | |
740 @end defopt | |
741 | |
742 @defopt warning-suppress-types | |
743 This list specifies which warning types should not be displayed | |
744 immediately for the user. Each element of the list should be a list | |
745 of symbols. If its elements match the first elements in a warning | |
746 type, then that warning is not displayed immediately. | |
747 @end defopt | |
748 | |
749 @defopt warning-suppress-log-types | |
750 This list specifies which warning types should not be logged in the | |
751 warnings buffer. Each element of the list should be a list of | |
752 symbols. If it matches the first few elements in a warning type, then | |
753 that warning is not logged. | |
754 @end defopt | |
755 | |
756 @node Invisible Text | |
757 @section Invisible Text | |
758 | |
759 @cindex invisible text | |
760 You can make characters @dfn{invisible}, so that they do not appear on | |
761 the screen, with the @code{invisible} property. This can be either a | |
762 text property (@pxref{Text Properties}) or a property of an overlay | |
763 (@pxref{Overlays}). Cursor motion also partly ignores these | |
764 characters; if the command loop finds point within them, it moves | |
765 point to the other side of them. | |
766 | |
767 In the simplest case, any non-@code{nil} @code{invisible} property makes | |
768 a character invisible. This is the default case---if you don't alter | |
769 the default value of @code{buffer-invisibility-spec}, this is how the | |
770 @code{invisible} property works. You should normally use @code{t} | |
771 as the value of the @code{invisible} property if you don't plan | |
772 to set @code{buffer-invisibility-spec} yourself. | |
773 | |
774 More generally, you can use the variable @code{buffer-invisibility-spec} | |
775 to control which values of the @code{invisible} property make text | |
776 invisible. This permits you to classify the text into different subsets | |
777 in advance, by giving them different @code{invisible} values, and | |
778 subsequently make various subsets visible or invisible by changing the | |
779 value of @code{buffer-invisibility-spec}. | |
780 | |
781 Controlling visibility with @code{buffer-invisibility-spec} is | |
782 especially useful in a program to display the list of entries in a | |
783 database. It permits the implementation of convenient filtering | |
784 commands to view just a part of the entries in the database. Setting | |
785 this variable is very fast, much faster than scanning all the text in | |
786 the buffer looking for properties to change. | |
787 | |
788 @defvar buffer-invisibility-spec | |
789 This variable specifies which kinds of @code{invisible} properties | |
790 actually make a character invisible. Setting this variable makes it | |
791 buffer-local. | |
792 | |
793 @table @asis | |
794 @item @code{t} | |
795 A character is invisible if its @code{invisible} property is | |
796 non-@code{nil}. This is the default. | |
797 | |
798 @item a list | |
799 Each element of the list specifies a criterion for invisibility; if a | |
800 character's @code{invisible} property fits any one of these criteria, | |
801 the character is invisible. The list can have two kinds of elements: | |
802 | |
803 @table @code | |
804 @item @var{atom} | |
805 A character is invisible if its @code{invisible} property value | |
806 is @var{atom} or if it is a list with @var{atom} as a member. | |
807 | |
808 @item (@var{atom} . t) | |
809 A character is invisible if its @code{invisible} property value is | |
810 @var{atom} or if it is a list with @var{atom} as a member. Moreover, | |
811 a sequence of such characters displays as an ellipsis. | |
812 @end table | |
813 @end table | |
814 @end defvar | |
815 | |
816 Two functions are specifically provided for adding elements to | |
817 @code{buffer-invisibility-spec} and removing elements from it. | |
818 | |
819 @defun add-to-invisibility-spec element | |
820 This function adds the element @var{element} to | |
821 @code{buffer-invisibility-spec}. If @code{buffer-invisibility-spec} | |
822 was @code{t}, it changes to a list, @code{(t)}, so that text whose | |
823 @code{invisible} property is @code{t} remains invisible. | |
824 @end defun | |
825 | |
826 @defun remove-from-invisibility-spec element | |
827 This removes the element @var{element} from | |
828 @code{buffer-invisibility-spec}. This does nothing if @var{element} | |
829 is not in the list. | |
830 @end defun | |
831 | |
832 A convention for use of @code{buffer-invisibility-spec} is that a | |
833 major mode should use the mode's own name as an element of | |
834 @code{buffer-invisibility-spec} and as the value of the | |
835 @code{invisible} property: | |
836 | |
837 @example | |
838 ;; @r{If you want to display an ellipsis:} | |
839 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t)) | |
840 ;; @r{If you don't want ellipsis:} | |
841 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol) | |
842 | |
843 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) | |
844 'invisible 'my-symbol) | |
845 | |
846 ;; @r{When done with the overlays:} | |
847 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t)) | |
848 ;; @r{Or respectively:} | |
849 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol) | |
850 @end example | |
851 | |
102950
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
852 You can check for invisibility using the following function: |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
853 |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
854 @defun invisible-p pos-or-prop |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
855 If @var{pos-or-prop} is a marker or number, this function returns a |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
856 non-@code{nil} value if the text at that position is invisible. |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
857 |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
858 If @var{pos-or-prop} is any other kind of Lisp object, that is taken |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
859 to mean a possible value of the @code{invisible} text or overlay |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
860 property. In that case, this function returns a non-@code{nil} value |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
861 if that value would cause text to become invisible, based on the |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
862 current value of @code{buffer-invisibility-spec}. |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
863 @end defun |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
864 |
84060 | 865 @vindex line-move-ignore-invisible |
866 Ordinarily, functions that operate on text or move point do not care | |
867 whether the text is invisible. The user-level line motion commands | |
102950
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
868 ignore invisible newlines if @code{line-move-ignore-invisible} is |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
869 non-@code{nil} (the default), but only because they are explicitly |
6a1a6758ec3e
* display.texi (Refresh Screen): Note that a passage about screen
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102932
diff
changeset
|
870 programmed to do so. |
84060 | 871 |
872 However, if a command ends with point inside or immediately before | |
873 invisible text, the main editing loop moves point further forward or | |
874 further backward (in the same direction that the command already moved | |
875 it) until that condition is no longer true. Thus, if the command | |
876 moved point back into an invisible range, Emacs moves point back to | |
877 the beginning of that range, and then back one more character. If the | |
878 command moved point forward into an invisible range, Emacs moves point | |
879 forward up to the first visible character that follows the invisible | |
880 text. | |
881 | |
882 Incremental search can make invisible overlays visible temporarily | |
883 and/or permanently when a match includes invisible text. To enable | |
884 this, the overlay should have a non-@code{nil} | |
885 @code{isearch-open-invisible} property. The property value should be a | |
886 function to be called with the overlay as an argument. This function | |
887 should make the overlay visible permanently; it is used when the match | |
888 overlaps the overlay on exit from the search. | |
889 | |
890 During the search, such overlays are made temporarily visible by | |
891 temporarily modifying their invisible and intangible properties. If you | |
892 want this to be done differently for a certain overlay, give it an | |
893 @code{isearch-open-invisible-temporary} property which is a function. | |
894 The function is called with two arguments: the first is the overlay, and | |
895 the second is @code{nil} to make the overlay visible, or @code{t} to | |
896 make it invisible again. | |
897 | |
898 @node Selective Display | |
899 @section Selective Display | |
900 @c @cindex selective display Duplicates selective-display | |
901 | |
902 @dfn{Selective display} refers to a pair of related features for | |
903 hiding certain lines on the screen. | |
904 | |
905 The first variant, explicit selective display, is designed for use | |
906 in a Lisp program: it controls which lines are hidden by altering the | |
907 text. This kind of hiding in some ways resembles the effect of the | |
908 @code{invisible} property (@pxref{Invisible Text}), but the two | |
909 features are different and do not work the same way. | |
910 | |
911 In the second variant, the choice of lines to hide is made | |
912 automatically based on indentation. This variant is designed to be a | |
913 user-level feature. | |
914 | |
915 The way you control explicit selective display is by replacing a | |
916 newline (control-j) with a carriage return (control-m). The text that | |
917 was formerly a line following that newline is now hidden. Strictly | |
918 speaking, it is temporarily no longer a line at all, since only | |
919 newlines can separate lines; it is now part of the previous line. | |
920 | |
921 Selective display does not directly affect editing commands. For | |
922 example, @kbd{C-f} (@code{forward-char}) moves point unhesitatingly | |
923 into hidden text. However, the replacement of newline characters with | |
924 carriage return characters affects some editing commands. For | |
925 example, @code{next-line} skips hidden lines, since it searches only | |
926 for newlines. Modes that use selective display can also define | |
927 commands that take account of the newlines, or that control which | |
928 parts of the text are hidden. | |
929 | |
930 When you write a selectively displayed buffer into a file, all the | |
931 control-m's are output as newlines. This means that when you next read | |
932 in the file, it looks OK, with nothing hidden. The selective display | |
933 effect is seen only within Emacs. | |
934 | |
935 @defvar selective-display | |
936 This buffer-local variable enables selective display. This means that | |
937 lines, or portions of lines, may be made hidden. | |
938 | |
939 @itemize @bullet | |
940 @item | |
941 If the value of @code{selective-display} is @code{t}, then the character | |
942 control-m marks the start of hidden text; the control-m, and the rest | |
943 of the line following it, are not displayed. This is explicit selective | |
944 display. | |
945 | |
946 @item | |
947 If the value of @code{selective-display} is a positive integer, then | |
948 lines that start with more than that many columns of indentation are not | |
949 displayed. | |
950 @end itemize | |
951 | |
952 When some portion of a buffer is hidden, the vertical movement | |
953 commands operate as if that portion did not exist, allowing a single | |
954 @code{next-line} command to skip any number of hidden lines. | |
955 However, character movement commands (such as @code{forward-char}) do | |
956 not skip the hidden portion, and it is possible (if tricky) to insert | |
957 or delete text in an hidden portion. | |
958 | |
959 In the examples below, we show the @emph{display appearance} of the | |
960 buffer @code{foo}, which changes with the value of | |
961 @code{selective-display}. The @emph{contents} of the buffer do not | |
962 change. | |
963 | |
964 @example | |
965 @group | |
966 (setq selective-display nil) | |
967 @result{} nil | |
968 | |
969 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
970 1 on this column | |
971 2on this column | |
972 3n this column | |
973 3n this column | |
974 2on this column | |
975 1 on this column | |
976 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
977 @end group | |
978 | |
979 @group | |
980 (setq selective-display 2) | |
981 @result{} 2 | |
982 | |
983 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
984 1 on this column | |
985 2on this column | |
986 2on this column | |
987 1 on this column | |
988 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
989 @end group | |
990 @end example | |
991 @end defvar | |
992 | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
993 @defopt selective-display-ellipses |
84060 | 994 If this buffer-local variable is non-@code{nil}, then Emacs displays |
995 @samp{@dots{}} at the end of a line that is followed by hidden text. | |
996 This example is a continuation of the previous one. | |
997 | |
998 @example | |
999 @group | |
1000 (setq selective-display-ellipses t) | |
1001 @result{} t | |
1002 | |
1003 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
1004 1 on this column | |
1005 2on this column ... | |
1006 2on this column | |
1007 1 on this column | |
1008 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
1009 @end group | |
1010 @end example | |
1011 | |
1012 You can use a display table to substitute other text for the ellipsis | |
1013 (@samp{@dots{}}). @xref{Display Tables}. | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
1014 @end defopt |
84060 | 1015 |
1016 @node Temporary Displays | |
1017 @section Temporary Displays | |
1018 | |
1019 Temporary displays are used by Lisp programs to put output into a | |
1020 buffer and then present it to the user for perusal rather than for | |
1021 editing. Many help commands use this feature. | |
1022 | |
1023 @defspec with-output-to-temp-buffer buffer-name forms@dots{} | |
1024 This function executes @var{forms} while arranging to insert any output | |
1025 they print into the buffer named @var{buffer-name}, which is first | |
1026 created if necessary, and put into Help mode. Finally, the buffer is | |
1027 displayed in some window, but not selected. | |
1028 | |
1029 If the @var{forms} do not change the major mode in the output buffer, | |
1030 so that it is still Help mode at the end of their execution, then | |
1031 @code{with-output-to-temp-buffer} makes this buffer read-only at the | |
1032 end, and also scans it for function and variable names to make them | |
1033 into clickable cross-references. @xref{Docstring hyperlinks, , Tips | |
1034 for Documentation Strings}, in particular the item on hyperlinks in | |
1035 documentation strings, for more details. | |
1036 | |
1037 The string @var{buffer-name} specifies the temporary buffer, which | |
1038 need not already exist. The argument must be a string, not a buffer. | |
1039 The buffer is erased initially (with no questions asked), and it is | |
1040 marked as unmodified after @code{with-output-to-temp-buffer} exits. | |
1041 | |
1042 @code{with-output-to-temp-buffer} binds @code{standard-output} to the | |
1043 temporary buffer, then it evaluates the forms in @var{forms}. Output | |
1044 using the Lisp output functions within @var{forms} goes by default to | |
1045 that buffer (but screen display and messages in the echo area, although | |
1046 they are ``output'' in the general sense of the word, are not affected). | |
1047 @xref{Output Functions}. | |
1048 | |
1049 Several hooks are available for customizing the behavior | |
1050 of this construct; they are listed below. | |
1051 | |
1052 The value of the last form in @var{forms} is returned. | |
1053 | |
1054 @example | |
1055 @group | |
1056 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
1057 This is the contents of foo. | |
1058 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
1059 @end group | |
1060 | |
1061 @group | |
1062 (with-output-to-temp-buffer "foo" | |
1063 (print 20) | |
1064 (print standard-output)) | |
1065 @result{} #<buffer foo> | |
1066 | |
1067 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
1068 20 | |
1069 | |
1070 #<buffer foo> | |
1071 | |
1072 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
1073 @end group | |
1074 @end example | |
1075 @end defspec | |
1076 | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
1077 @defopt temp-buffer-show-function |
84060 | 1078 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, @code{with-output-to-temp-buffer} |
1079 calls it as a function to do the job of displaying a help buffer. The | |
1080 function gets one argument, which is the buffer it should display. | |
1081 | |
1082 It is a good idea for this function to run @code{temp-buffer-show-hook} | |
1083 just as @code{with-output-to-temp-buffer} normally would, inside of | |
1084 @code{save-selected-window} and with the chosen window and buffer | |
1085 selected. | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
1086 @end defopt |
84060 | 1087 |
1088 @defvar temp-buffer-setup-hook | |
1089 This normal hook is run by @code{with-output-to-temp-buffer} before | |
1090 evaluating @var{body}. When the hook runs, the temporary buffer is | |
1091 current. This hook is normally set up with a function to put the | |
1092 buffer in Help mode. | |
1093 @end defvar | |
1094 | |
1095 @defvar temp-buffer-show-hook | |
1096 This normal hook is run by @code{with-output-to-temp-buffer} after | |
1097 displaying the temporary buffer. When the hook runs, the temporary buffer | |
97627
33d44d4ba1ed
(Temporary Displays): Remove unnecessary comment about usage of
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97043
diff
changeset
|
1098 is current, and the window it was displayed in is selected. |
84060 | 1099 @end defvar |
1100 | |
1101 @defun momentary-string-display string position &optional char message | |
1102 This function momentarily displays @var{string} in the current buffer at | |
1103 @var{position}. It has no effect on the undo list or on the buffer's | |
1104 modification status. | |
1105 | |
1106 The momentary display remains until the next input event. If the next | |
1107 input event is @var{char}, @code{momentary-string-display} ignores it | |
1108 and returns. Otherwise, that event remains buffered for subsequent use | |
1109 as input. Thus, typing @var{char} will simply remove the string from | |
1110 the display, while typing (say) @kbd{C-f} will remove the string from | |
1111 the display and later (presumably) move point forward. The argument | |
1112 @var{char} is a space by default. | |
1113 | |
1114 The return value of @code{momentary-string-display} is not meaningful. | |
1115 | |
1116 If the string @var{string} does not contain control characters, you can | |
1117 do the same job in a more general way by creating (and then subsequently | |
1118 deleting) an overlay with a @code{before-string} property. | |
1119 @xref{Overlay Properties}. | |
1120 | |
1121 If @var{message} is non-@code{nil}, it is displayed in the echo area | |
1122 while @var{string} is displayed in the buffer. If it is @code{nil}, a | |
1123 default message says to type @var{char} to continue. | |
1124 | |
1125 In this example, point is initially located at the beginning of the | |
1126 second line: | |
1127 | |
1128 @example | |
1129 @group | |
1130 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
1131 This is the contents of foo. | |
1132 @point{}Second line. | |
1133 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
1134 @end group | |
1135 | |
1136 @group | |
1137 (momentary-string-display | |
1138 "**** Important Message! ****" | |
1139 (point) ?\r | |
1140 "Type RET when done reading") | |
1141 @result{} t | |
1142 @end group | |
1143 | |
1144 @group | |
1145 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
1146 This is the contents of foo. | |
1147 **** Important Message! ****Second line. | |
1148 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
1149 | |
1150 ---------- Echo Area ---------- | |
1151 Type RET when done reading | |
1152 ---------- Echo Area ---------- | |
1153 @end group | |
1154 @end example | |
1155 @end defun | |
1156 | |
1157 @node Overlays | |
1158 @section Overlays | |
1159 @cindex overlays | |
1160 | |
1161 You can use @dfn{overlays} to alter the appearance of a buffer's text on | |
1162 the screen, for the sake of presentation features. An overlay is an | |
1163 object that belongs to a particular buffer, and has a specified | |
1164 beginning and end. It also has properties that you can examine and set; | |
1165 these affect the display of the text within the overlay. | |
1166 | |
102932
12eccf796fc2
(Overlays): Overlays don't scale well. See
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
102893
diff
changeset
|
1167 @cindex scalability of overlays |
12eccf796fc2
(Overlays): Overlays don't scale well. See
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
102893
diff
changeset
|
1168 The visual effect of an overlay is the same as of the corresponding |
12eccf796fc2
(Overlays): Overlays don't scale well. See
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
102893
diff
changeset
|
1169 text property (@pxref{Text Properties}). However, due to a different |
12eccf796fc2
(Overlays): Overlays don't scale well. See
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
102893
diff
changeset
|
1170 implementation, overlays generally don't scale well (many operations |
12eccf796fc2
(Overlays): Overlays don't scale well. See
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
102893
diff
changeset
|
1171 take a time that is proportional to the number of overlays in the |
12eccf796fc2
(Overlays): Overlays don't scale well. See
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
102893
diff
changeset
|
1172 buffer). If you need to affect the visual appearance of many portions |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
1173 in the buffer, we recommend using text properties. |
102932
12eccf796fc2
(Overlays): Overlays don't scale well. See
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
102893
diff
changeset
|
1174 |
84060 | 1175 An overlay uses markers to record its beginning and end; thus, |
1176 editing the text of the buffer adjusts the beginning and end of each | |
1177 overlay so that it stays with the text. When you create the overlay, | |
1178 you can specify whether text inserted at the beginning should be | |
1179 inside the overlay or outside, and likewise for the end of the overlay. | |
1180 | |
1181 @menu | |
1182 * Managing Overlays:: Creating and moving overlays. | |
1183 * Overlay Properties:: How to read and set properties. | |
1184 What properties do to the screen display. | |
1185 * Finding Overlays:: Searching for overlays. | |
1186 @end menu | |
1187 | |
1188 @node Managing Overlays | |
1189 @subsection Managing Overlays | |
1190 | |
1191 This section describes the functions to create, delete and move | |
1192 overlays, and to examine their contents. Overlay changes are not | |
1193 recorded in the buffer's undo list, since the overlays are not | |
1194 part of the buffer's contents. | |
1195 | |
1196 @defun overlayp object | |
1197 This function returns @code{t} if @var{object} is an overlay. | |
1198 @end defun | |
1199 | |
1200 @defun make-overlay start end &optional buffer front-advance rear-advance | |
1201 This function creates and returns an overlay that belongs to | |
1202 @var{buffer} and ranges from @var{start} to @var{end}. Both @var{start} | |
1203 and @var{end} must specify buffer positions; they may be integers or | |
1204 markers. If @var{buffer} is omitted, the overlay is created in the | |
1205 current buffer. | |
1206 | |
1207 The arguments @var{front-advance} and @var{rear-advance} specify the | |
1208 marker insertion type for the start of the overlay and for the end of | |
1209 the overlay, respectively. @xref{Marker Insertion Types}. If they | |
1210 are both @code{nil}, the default, then the overlay extends to include | |
1211 any text inserted at the beginning, but not text inserted at the end. | |
1212 If @var{front-advance} is non-@code{nil}, text inserted at the | |
1213 beginning of the overlay is excluded from the overlay. If | |
1214 @var{rear-advance} is non-@code{nil}, text inserted at the end of the | |
1215 overlay is included in the overlay. | |
1216 @end defun | |
1217 | |
1218 @defun overlay-start overlay | |
1219 This function returns the position at which @var{overlay} starts, | |
1220 as an integer. | |
1221 @end defun | |
1222 | |
1223 @defun overlay-end overlay | |
1224 This function returns the position at which @var{overlay} ends, | |
1225 as an integer. | |
1226 @end defun | |
1227 | |
1228 @defun overlay-buffer overlay | |
1229 This function returns the buffer that @var{overlay} belongs to. It | |
1230 returns @code{nil} if @var{overlay} has been deleted. | |
1231 @end defun | |
1232 | |
1233 @defun delete-overlay overlay | |
1234 This function deletes @var{overlay}. The overlay continues to exist as | |
1235 a Lisp object, and its property list is unchanged, but it ceases to be | |
1236 attached to the buffer it belonged to, and ceases to have any effect on | |
1237 display. | |
1238 | |
1239 A deleted overlay is not permanently disconnected. You can give it a | |
1240 position in a buffer again by calling @code{move-overlay}. | |
1241 @end defun | |
1242 | |
1243 @defun move-overlay overlay start end &optional buffer | |
1244 This function moves @var{overlay} to @var{buffer}, and places its bounds | |
1245 at @var{start} and @var{end}. Both arguments @var{start} and @var{end} | |
1246 must specify buffer positions; they may be integers or markers. | |
1247 | |
1248 If @var{buffer} is omitted, @var{overlay} stays in the same buffer it | |
1249 was already associated with; if @var{overlay} was deleted, it goes into | |
1250 the current buffer. | |
1251 | |
1252 The return value is @var{overlay}. | |
1253 | |
1254 This is the only valid way to change the endpoints of an overlay. Do | |
1255 not try modifying the markers in the overlay by hand, as that fails to | |
1256 update other vital data structures and can cause some overlays to be | |
1257 ``lost.'' | |
1258 @end defun | |
1259 | |
1260 @defun remove-overlays &optional start end name value | |
1261 This function removes all the overlays between @var{start} and | |
1262 @var{end} whose property @var{name} has the value @var{value}. It can | |
1263 move the endpoints of the overlays in the region, or split them. | |
1264 | |
1265 If @var{name} is omitted or @code{nil}, it means to delete all overlays in | |
1266 the specified region. If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are omitted or | |
1267 @code{nil}, that means the beginning and end of the buffer respectively. | |
1268 Therefore, @code{(remove-overlays)} removes all the overlays in the | |
1269 current buffer. | |
1270 @end defun | |
1271 | |
105192
43be71d128b2
* display.texi (Managing Overlays): Document copy-overlay (Bug#4549).
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
104766
diff
changeset
|
1272 @defun copy-overlay overlay |
43be71d128b2
* display.texi (Managing Overlays): Document copy-overlay (Bug#4549).
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
104766
diff
changeset
|
1273 This function returns a copy of @var{overlay}. The copy has the same |
43be71d128b2
* display.texi (Managing Overlays): Document copy-overlay (Bug#4549).
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
104766
diff
changeset
|
1274 endpoints and properties as @var{overlay}. However, the marker |
43be71d128b2
* display.texi (Managing Overlays): Document copy-overlay (Bug#4549).
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
104766
diff
changeset
|
1275 insertion type for the start of the overlay and for the end of the |
43be71d128b2
* display.texi (Managing Overlays): Document copy-overlay (Bug#4549).
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
104766
diff
changeset
|
1276 overlay are set to their default values (@pxref{Marker Insertion |
43be71d128b2
* display.texi (Managing Overlays): Document copy-overlay (Bug#4549).
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
104766
diff
changeset
|
1277 Types}). |
43be71d128b2
* display.texi (Managing Overlays): Document copy-overlay (Bug#4549).
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
104766
diff
changeset
|
1278 @end defun |
43be71d128b2
* display.texi (Managing Overlays): Document copy-overlay (Bug#4549).
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
104766
diff
changeset
|
1279 |
84060 | 1280 Here are some examples: |
1281 | |
1282 @example | |
1283 ;; @r{Create an overlay.} | |
1284 (setq foo (make-overlay 1 10)) | |
1285 @result{} #<overlay from 1 to 10 in display.texi> | |
1286 (overlay-start foo) | |
1287 @result{} 1 | |
1288 (overlay-end foo) | |
1289 @result{} 10 | |
1290 (overlay-buffer foo) | |
1291 @result{} #<buffer display.texi> | |
1292 ;; @r{Give it a property we can check later.} | |
1293 (overlay-put foo 'happy t) | |
1294 @result{} t | |
1295 ;; @r{Verify the property is present.} | |
1296 (overlay-get foo 'happy) | |
1297 @result{} t | |
1298 ;; @r{Move the overlay.} | |
1299 (move-overlay foo 5 20) | |
1300 @result{} #<overlay from 5 to 20 in display.texi> | |
1301 (overlay-start foo) | |
1302 @result{} 5 | |
1303 (overlay-end foo) | |
1304 @result{} 20 | |
1305 ;; @r{Delete the overlay.} | |
1306 (delete-overlay foo) | |
1307 @result{} nil | |
1308 ;; @r{Verify it is deleted.} | |
1309 foo | |
1310 @result{} #<overlay in no buffer> | |
1311 ;; @r{A deleted overlay has no position.} | |
1312 (overlay-start foo) | |
1313 @result{} nil | |
1314 (overlay-end foo) | |
1315 @result{} nil | |
1316 (overlay-buffer foo) | |
1317 @result{} nil | |
1318 ;; @r{Undelete the overlay.} | |
1319 (move-overlay foo 1 20) | |
1320 @result{} #<overlay from 1 to 20 in display.texi> | |
1321 ;; @r{Verify the results.} | |
1322 (overlay-start foo) | |
1323 @result{} 1 | |
1324 (overlay-end foo) | |
1325 @result{} 20 | |
1326 (overlay-buffer foo) | |
1327 @result{} #<buffer display.texi> | |
1328 ;; @r{Moving and deleting the overlay does not change its properties.} | |
1329 (overlay-get foo 'happy) | |
1330 @result{} t | |
1331 @end example | |
1332 | |
1333 Emacs stores the overlays of each buffer in two lists, divided | |
1334 around an arbitrary ``center position.'' One list extends backwards | |
1335 through the buffer from that center position, and the other extends | |
1336 forwards from that center position. The center position can be anywhere | |
1337 in the buffer. | |
1338 | |
1339 @defun overlay-recenter pos | |
1340 This function recenters the overlays of the current buffer around | |
1341 position @var{pos}. That makes overlay lookup faster for positions | |
1342 near @var{pos}, but slower for positions far away from @var{pos}. | |
1343 @end defun | |
1344 | |
1345 A loop that scans the buffer forwards, creating overlays, can run | |
1346 faster if you do @code{(overlay-recenter (point-max))} first. | |
1347 | |
1348 @node Overlay Properties | |
1349 @subsection Overlay Properties | |
1350 | |
1351 Overlay properties are like text properties in that the properties that | |
1352 alter how a character is displayed can come from either source. But in | |
1353 most respects they are different. @xref{Text Properties}, for comparison. | |
1354 | |
1355 Text properties are considered a part of the text; overlays and | |
1356 their properties are specifically considered not to be part of the | |
1357 text. Thus, copying text between various buffers and strings | |
1358 preserves text properties, but does not try to preserve overlays. | |
1359 Changing a buffer's text properties marks the buffer as modified, | |
1360 while moving an overlay or changing its properties does not. Unlike | |
1361 text property changes, overlay property changes are not recorded in | |
1362 the buffer's undo list. | |
1363 | |
85004
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1364 Since more than one overlay can specify a property value for the |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1365 same character, Emacs lets you specify a priority value of each |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1366 overlay. You should not make assumptions about which overlay will |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1367 prevail when there is a conflict and they have the same priority. |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1368 |
84060 | 1369 These functions read and set the properties of an overlay: |
1370 | |
1371 @defun overlay-get overlay prop | |
1372 This function returns the value of property @var{prop} recorded in | |
1373 @var{overlay}, if any. If @var{overlay} does not record any value for | |
1374 that property, but it does have a @code{category} property which is a | |
1375 symbol, that symbol's @var{prop} property is used. Otherwise, the value | |
1376 is @code{nil}. | |
1377 @end defun | |
1378 | |
1379 @defun overlay-put overlay prop value | |
1380 This function sets the value of property @var{prop} recorded in | |
1381 @var{overlay} to @var{value}. It returns @var{value}. | |
1382 @end defun | |
1383 | |
1384 @defun overlay-properties overlay | |
1385 This returns a copy of the property list of @var{overlay}. | |
1386 @end defun | |
1387 | |
1388 See also the function @code{get-char-property} which checks both | |
1389 overlay properties and text properties for a given character. | |
1390 @xref{Examining Properties}. | |
1391 | |
1392 Many overlay properties have special meanings; here is a table | |
1393 of them: | |
1394 | |
1395 @table @code | |
1396 @item priority | |
1397 @kindex priority @r{(overlay property)} | |
1398 This property's value (which should be a nonnegative integer number) | |
85004
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1399 determines the priority of the overlay. No priority, or @code{nil}, |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1400 means zero. |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1401 |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1402 The priority matters when two or more overlays cover the same |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1403 character and both specify the same property; the one whose |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1404 @code{priority} value is larger overrides the other. For the |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1405 @code{face} property, the higher priority overlay's value does not |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1406 completely override the other value; instead, its face attributes |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1407 override the face attributes of the lower priority @code{face} |
b516a4e62b87
(Overlay Properties): Explain nil as priority. Explain that conflicts
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
84116
diff
changeset
|
1408 property. |
84060 | 1409 |
1410 Currently, all overlays take priority over text properties. Please | |
1411 avoid using negative priority values, as we have not yet decided just | |
1412 what they should mean. | |
1413 | |
1414 @item window | |
1415 @kindex window @r{(overlay property)} | |
1416 If the @code{window} property is non-@code{nil}, then the overlay | |
1417 applies only on that window. | |
1418 | |
1419 @item category | |
1420 @kindex category @r{(overlay property)} | |
1421 If an overlay has a @code{category} property, we call it the | |
1422 @dfn{category} of the overlay. It should be a symbol. The properties | |
1423 of the symbol serve as defaults for the properties of the overlay. | |
1424 | |
1425 @item face | |
1426 @kindex face @r{(overlay property)} | |
1427 This property controls the way text is displayed---for example, which | |
1428 font and which colors. @xref{Faces}, for more information. | |
1429 | |
1430 In the simplest case, the value is a face name. It can also be a list; | |
1431 then each element can be any of these possibilities: | |
1432 | |
1433 @itemize @bullet | |
1434 @item | |
1435 A face name (a symbol or string). | |
1436 | |
1437 @item | |
1438 A property list of face attributes. This has the form (@var{keyword} | |
1439 @var{value} @dots{}), where each @var{keyword} is a face attribute | |
1440 name and @var{value} is a meaningful value for that attribute. With | |
1441 this feature, you do not need to create a face each time you want to | |
1442 specify a particular attribute for certain text. @xref{Face | |
1443 Attributes}. | |
1444 | |
1445 @item | |
1446 A cons cell, either of the form @code{(foreground-color . @var{color-name})} or | |
1447 @code{(background-color . @var{color-name})}. These elements specify | |
1448 just the foreground color or just the background color. | |
1449 | |
1450 @code{(foreground-color . @var{color-name})} has the same effect as | |
1451 @code{(:foreground @var{color-name})}; likewise for the background. | |
1452 @end itemize | |
1453 | |
1454 @item mouse-face | |
1455 @kindex mouse-face @r{(overlay property)} | |
1456 This property is used instead of @code{face} when the mouse is within | |
1457 the range of the overlay. | |
1458 | |
1459 @item display | |
1460 @kindex display @r{(overlay property)} | |
1461 This property activates various features that change the | |
1462 way text is displayed. For example, it can make text appear taller | |
1463 or shorter, higher or lower, wider or narrower, or replaced with an image. | |
1464 @xref{Display Property}. | |
1465 | |
1466 @item help-echo | |
1467 @kindex help-echo @r{(overlay property)} | |
1468 If an overlay has a @code{help-echo} property, then when you move the | |
1469 mouse onto the text in the overlay, Emacs displays a help string in the | |
1470 echo area, or in the tooltip window. For details see @ref{Text | |
1471 help-echo}. | |
1472 | |
1473 @item modification-hooks | |
1474 @kindex modification-hooks @r{(overlay property)} | |
1475 This property's value is a list of functions to be called if any | |
1476 character within the overlay is changed or if text is inserted strictly | |
1477 within the overlay. | |
1478 | |
1479 The hook functions are called both before and after each change. | |
1480 If the functions save the information they receive, and compare notes | |
1481 between calls, they can determine exactly what change has been made | |
1482 in the buffer text. | |
1483 | |
1484 When called before a change, each function receives four arguments: the | |
1485 overlay, @code{nil}, and the beginning and end of the text range to be | |
1486 modified. | |
1487 | |
1488 When called after a change, each function receives five arguments: the | |
1489 overlay, @code{t}, the beginning and end of the text range just | |
1490 modified, and the length of the pre-change text replaced by that range. | |
1491 (For an insertion, the pre-change length is zero; for a deletion, that | |
1492 length is the number of characters deleted, and the post-change | |
1493 beginning and end are equal.) | |
1494 | |
1495 If these functions modify the buffer, they should bind | |
1496 @code{inhibit-modification-hooks} to @code{t} around doing so, to | |
1497 avoid confusing the internal mechanism that calls these hooks. | |
1498 | |
1499 Text properties also support the @code{modification-hooks} property, | |
1500 but the details are somewhat different (@pxref{Special Properties}). | |
1501 | |
1502 @item insert-in-front-hooks | |
1503 @kindex insert-in-front-hooks @r{(overlay property)} | |
1504 This property's value is a list of functions to be called before and | |
1505 after inserting text right at the beginning of the overlay. The calling | |
1506 conventions are the same as for the @code{modification-hooks} functions. | |
1507 | |
1508 @item insert-behind-hooks | |
1509 @kindex insert-behind-hooks @r{(overlay property)} | |
1510 This property's value is a list of functions to be called before and | |
1511 after inserting text right at the end of the overlay. The calling | |
1512 conventions are the same as for the @code{modification-hooks} functions. | |
1513 | |
1514 @item invisible | |
1515 @kindex invisible @r{(overlay property)} | |
1516 The @code{invisible} property can make the text in the overlay | |
1517 invisible, which means that it does not appear on the screen. | |
1518 @xref{Invisible Text}, for details. | |
1519 | |
1520 @item intangible | |
1521 @kindex intangible @r{(overlay property)} | |
1522 The @code{intangible} property on an overlay works just like the | |
1523 @code{intangible} text property. @xref{Special Properties}, for details. | |
1524 | |
1525 @item isearch-open-invisible | |
1526 This property tells incremental search how to make an invisible overlay | |
1527 visible, permanently, if the final match overlaps it. @xref{Invisible | |
1528 Text}. | |
1529 | |
1530 @item isearch-open-invisible-temporary | |
1531 This property tells incremental search how to make an invisible overlay | |
1532 visible, temporarily, during the search. @xref{Invisible Text}. | |
1533 | |
1534 @item before-string | |
1535 @kindex before-string @r{(overlay property)} | |
1536 This property's value is a string to add to the display at the beginning | |
1537 of the overlay. The string does not appear in the buffer in any | |
1538 sense---only on the screen. | |
1539 | |
1540 @item after-string | |
1541 @kindex after-string @r{(overlay property)} | |
1542 This property's value is a string to add to the display at the end of | |
1543 the overlay. The string does not appear in the buffer in any | |
1544 sense---only on the screen. | |
1545 | |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
1546 @item line-prefix |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
1547 This property specifies a display spec to prepend to each |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
1548 non-continuation line at display-time. @xref{Truncation}. |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
1549 |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
1550 @itemx wrap-prefix |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
1551 This property specifies a display spec to prepend to each continuation |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
1552 line at display-time. @xref{Truncation}. |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
1553 |
84060 | 1554 @item evaporate |
1555 @kindex evaporate @r{(overlay property)} | |
1556 If this property is non-@code{nil}, the overlay is deleted automatically | |
1557 if it becomes empty (i.e., if its length becomes zero). If you give | |
1558 an empty overlay a non-@code{nil} @code{evaporate} property, that deletes | |
1559 it immediately. | |
1560 | |
1561 @item local-map | |
1562 @cindex keymap of character (and overlays) | |
1563 @kindex local-map @r{(overlay property)} | |
1564 If this property is non-@code{nil}, it specifies a keymap for a portion | |
1565 of the text. The property's value replaces the buffer's local map, when | |
1566 the character after point is within the overlay. @xref{Active Keymaps}. | |
1567 | |
1568 @item keymap | |
1569 @kindex keymap @r{(overlay property)} | |
1570 The @code{keymap} property is similar to @code{local-map} but overrides the | |
1571 buffer's local map (and the map specified by the @code{local-map} | |
1572 property) rather than replacing it. | |
1573 @end table | |
1574 | |
94197
3ce489895028
(Overlay Properties): Clarify role of underlying textprop and overlay
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
92977
diff
changeset
|
1575 The @code{local-map} and @code{keymap} properties do not affect a |
3ce489895028
(Overlay Properties): Clarify role of underlying textprop and overlay
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
92977
diff
changeset
|
1576 string displayed by the @code{before-string}, @code{after-string}, or |
3ce489895028
(Overlay Properties): Clarify role of underlying textprop and overlay
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
92977
diff
changeset
|
1577 @code{display} properties. This is only relevant for mouse clicks and |
3ce489895028
(Overlay Properties): Clarify role of underlying textprop and overlay
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
92977
diff
changeset
|
1578 other mouse events that fall on the string, since point is never on |
3ce489895028
(Overlay Properties): Clarify role of underlying textprop and overlay
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
92977
diff
changeset
|
1579 the string. To bind special mouse events for the string, assign it a |
3ce489895028
(Overlay Properties): Clarify role of underlying textprop and overlay
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
92977
diff
changeset
|
1580 @code{local-map} or @code{keymap} text property. @xref{Special |
3ce489895028
(Overlay Properties): Clarify role of underlying textprop and overlay
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
92977
diff
changeset
|
1581 Properties}. |
3ce489895028
(Overlay Properties): Clarify role of underlying textprop and overlay
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
92977
diff
changeset
|
1582 |
84060 | 1583 @node Finding Overlays |
1584 @subsection Searching for Overlays | |
1585 | |
1586 @defun overlays-at pos | |
1587 This function returns a list of all the overlays that cover the | |
1588 character at position @var{pos} in the current buffer. The list is in | |
1589 no particular order. An overlay contains position @var{pos} if it | |
1590 begins at or before @var{pos}, and ends after @var{pos}. | |
1591 | |
1592 To illustrate usage, here is a Lisp function that returns a list of the | |
1593 overlays that specify property @var{prop} for the character at point: | |
1594 | |
1595 @smallexample | |
1596 (defun find-overlays-specifying (prop) | |
1597 (let ((overlays (overlays-at (point))) | |
1598 found) | |
1599 (while overlays | |
1600 (let ((overlay (car overlays))) | |
1601 (if (overlay-get overlay prop) | |
1602 (setq found (cons overlay found)))) | |
1603 (setq overlays (cdr overlays))) | |
1604 found)) | |
1605 @end smallexample | |
1606 @end defun | |
1607 | |
1608 @defun overlays-in beg end | |
1609 This function returns a list of the overlays that overlap the region | |
1610 @var{beg} through @var{end}. ``Overlap'' means that at least one | |
1611 character is contained within the overlay and also contained within the | |
1612 specified region; however, empty overlays are included in the result if | |
92977
8a79cbd87921
(Finding Overlays): Say that empty overlays at
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
92150
diff
changeset
|
1613 they are located at @var{beg}, strictly between @var{beg} and @var{end}, |
8a79cbd87921
(Finding Overlays): Say that empty overlays at
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
92150
diff
changeset
|
1614 or at @var{end} when @var{end} denotes the position at the end of the |
8a79cbd87921
(Finding Overlays): Say that empty overlays at
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
92150
diff
changeset
|
1615 buffer. |
84060 | 1616 @end defun |
1617 | |
1618 @defun next-overlay-change pos | |
1619 This function returns the buffer position of the next beginning or end | |
1620 of an overlay, after @var{pos}. If there is none, it returns | |
1621 @code{(point-max)}. | |
1622 @end defun | |
1623 | |
1624 @defun previous-overlay-change pos | |
1625 This function returns the buffer position of the previous beginning or | |
1626 end of an overlay, before @var{pos}. If there is none, it returns | |
1627 @code{(point-min)}. | |
1628 @end defun | |
1629 | |
1630 As an example, here's a simplified (and inefficient) version of the | |
1631 primitive function @code{next-single-char-property-change} | |
1632 (@pxref{Property Search}). It searches forward from position | |
1633 @var{pos} for the next position where the value of a given property | |
1634 @code{prop}, as obtained from either overlays or text properties, | |
1635 changes. | |
1636 | |
1637 @smallexample | |
1638 (defun next-single-char-property-change (position prop) | |
1639 (save-excursion | |
1640 (goto-char position) | |
1641 (let ((propval (get-char-property (point) prop))) | |
1642 (while (and (not (eobp)) | |
1643 (eq (get-char-property (point) prop) propval)) | |
1644 (goto-char (min (next-overlay-change (point)) | |
1645 (next-single-property-change (point) prop))))) | |
1646 (point))) | |
1647 @end smallexample | |
1648 | |
1649 @node Width | |
1650 @section Width | |
1651 | |
1652 Since not all characters have the same width, these functions let you | |
1653 check the width of a character. @xref{Primitive Indent}, and | |
1654 @ref{Screen Lines}, for related functions. | |
1655 | |
1656 @defun char-width char | |
1657 This function returns the width in columns of the character @var{char}, | |
1658 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window. | |
1659 @end defun | |
1660 | |
1661 @defun string-width string | |
1662 This function returns the width in columns of the string @var{string}, | |
1663 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window. | |
1664 @end defun | |
1665 | |
1666 @defun truncate-string-to-width string width &optional start-column padding ellipsis | |
1667 This function returns the part of @var{string} that fits within | |
1668 @var{width} columns, as a new string. | |
1669 | |
1670 If @var{string} does not reach @var{width}, then the result ends where | |
1671 @var{string} ends. If one multi-column character in @var{string} | |
1672 extends across the column @var{width}, that character is not included in | |
1673 the result. Thus, the result can fall short of @var{width} but cannot | |
1674 go beyond it. | |
1675 | |
1676 The optional argument @var{start-column} specifies the starting column. | |
1677 If this is non-@code{nil}, then the first @var{start-column} columns of | |
1678 the string are omitted from the value. If one multi-column character in | |
1679 @var{string} extends across the column @var{start-column}, that | |
1680 character is not included. | |
1681 | |
1682 The optional argument @var{padding}, if non-@code{nil}, is a padding | |
1683 character added at the beginning and end of the result string, to extend | |
1684 it to exactly @var{width} columns. The padding character is used at the | |
1685 end of the result if it falls short of @var{width}. It is also used at | |
1686 the beginning of the result if one multi-column character in | |
1687 @var{string} extends across the column @var{start-column}. | |
1688 | |
1689 If @var{ellipsis} is non-@code{nil}, it should be a string which will | |
1690 replace the end of @var{str} (including any padding) if it extends | |
1691 beyond @var{end-column}, unless the display width of @var{str} is | |
1692 equal to or less than the display width of @var{ellipsis}. If | |
1693 @var{ellipsis} is non-@code{nil} and not a string, it stands for | |
1694 @code{"..."}. | |
1695 | |
1696 @example | |
1697 (truncate-string-to-width "\tab\t" 12 4) | |
1698 @result{} "ab" | |
1699 (truncate-string-to-width "\tab\t" 12 4 ?\s) | |
1700 @result{} " ab " | |
1701 @end example | |
1702 @end defun | |
1703 | |
1704 @node Line Height | |
1705 @section Line Height | |
1706 @cindex line height | |
1707 | |
1708 The total height of each display line consists of the height of the | |
1709 contents of the line, plus optional additional vertical line spacing | |
1710 above or below the display line. | |
1711 | |
1712 The height of the line contents is the maximum height of any | |
1713 character or image on that display line, including the final newline | |
1714 if there is one. (A display line that is continued doesn't include a | |
1715 final newline.) That is the default line height, if you do nothing to | |
1716 specify a greater height. (In the most common case, this equals the | |
1717 height of the default frame font.) | |
1718 | |
1719 There are several ways to explicitly specify a larger line height, | |
1720 either by specifying an absolute height for the display line, or by | |
1721 specifying vertical space. However, no matter what you specify, the | |
1722 actual line height can never be less than the default. | |
1723 | |
1724 @kindex line-height @r{(text property)} | |
1725 A newline can have a @code{line-height} text or overlay property | |
1726 that controls the total height of the display line ending in that | |
1727 newline. | |
1728 | |
1729 If the property value is @code{t}, the newline character has no | |
1730 effect on the displayed height of the line---the visible contents | |
1731 alone determine the height. This is useful for tiling small images | |
1732 (or image slices) without adding blank areas between the images. | |
1733 | |
1734 If the property value is a list of the form @code{(@var{height} | |
1735 @var{total})}, that adds extra space @emph{below} the display line. | |
1736 First Emacs uses @var{height} as a height spec to control extra space | |
1737 @emph{above} the line; then it adds enough space @emph{below} the line | |
1738 to bring the total line height up to @var{total}. In this case, the | |
1739 other ways to specify the line spacing are ignored. | |
1740 | |
1741 Any other kind of property value is a height spec, which translates | |
1742 into a number---the specified line height. There are several ways to | |
1743 write a height spec; here's how each of them translates into a number: | |
1744 | |
1745 @table @code | |
1746 @item @var{integer} | |
1747 If the height spec is a positive integer, the height value is that integer. | |
1748 @item @var{float} | |
1749 If the height spec is a float, @var{float}, the numeric height value | |
1750 is @var{float} times the frame's default line height. | |
1751 @item (@var{face} . @var{ratio}) | |
1752 If the height spec is a cons of the format shown, the numeric height | |
1753 is @var{ratio} times the height of face @var{face}. @var{ratio} can | |
1754 be any type of number, or @code{nil} which means a ratio of 1. | |
1755 If @var{face} is @code{t}, it refers to the current face. | |
1756 @item (nil . @var{ratio}) | |
1757 If the height spec is a cons of the format shown, the numeric height | |
1758 is @var{ratio} times the height of the contents of the line. | |
1759 @end table | |
1760 | |
1761 Thus, any valid height spec determines the height in pixels, one way | |
1762 or another. If the line contents' height is less than that, Emacs | |
1763 adds extra vertical space above the line to achieve the specified | |
1764 total height. | |
1765 | |
1766 If you don't specify the @code{line-height} property, the line's | |
1767 height consists of the contents' height plus the line spacing. | |
1768 There are several ways to specify the line spacing for different | |
1769 parts of Emacs text. | |
1770 | |
1771 @vindex default-line-spacing | |
102981
789bf99f58e7
* display.texi (Line Height): Emphasize that line-spacing only takes
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102975
diff
changeset
|
1772 On graphical terminals, you can specify the line spacing for all |
789bf99f58e7
* display.texi (Line Height): Emphasize that line-spacing only takes
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102975
diff
changeset
|
1773 lines in a frame, using the @code{line-spacing} frame parameter |
104626
caa79498564a
* subr.el (default-mode-line-format, default-header-line-format)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104570
diff
changeset
|
1774 (@pxref{Layout Parameters}). However, if the default value of |
caa79498564a
* subr.el (default-mode-line-format, default-header-line-format)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104570
diff
changeset
|
1775 @code{line-spacing} is non-@code{nil}, it overrides the |
102981
789bf99f58e7
* display.texi (Line Height): Emphasize that line-spacing only takes
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102975
diff
changeset
|
1776 frame's @code{line-spacing} parameter. An integer value specifies the |
789bf99f58e7
* display.texi (Line Height): Emphasize that line-spacing only takes
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102975
diff
changeset
|
1777 number of pixels put below lines. A floating point number specifies |
789bf99f58e7
* display.texi (Line Height): Emphasize that line-spacing only takes
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102975
diff
changeset
|
1778 the spacing relative to the frame's default line height. |
84060 | 1779 |
1780 @vindex line-spacing | |
1781 You can specify the line spacing for all lines in a buffer via the | |
1782 buffer-local @code{line-spacing} variable. An integer value specifies | |
102981
789bf99f58e7
* display.texi (Line Height): Emphasize that line-spacing only takes
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102975
diff
changeset
|
1783 the number of pixels put below lines. A floating point number |
789bf99f58e7
* display.texi (Line Height): Emphasize that line-spacing only takes
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102975
diff
changeset
|
1784 specifies the spacing relative to the default frame line height. This |
789bf99f58e7
* display.texi (Line Height): Emphasize that line-spacing only takes
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102975
diff
changeset
|
1785 overrides line spacings specified for the frame. |
84060 | 1786 |
1787 @kindex line-spacing @r{(text property)} | |
1788 Finally, a newline can have a @code{line-spacing} text or overlay | |
1789 property that overrides the default frame line spacing and the buffer | |
1790 local @code{line-spacing} variable, for the display line ending in | |
1791 that newline. | |
1792 | |
1793 One way or another, these mechanisms specify a Lisp value for the | |
1794 spacing of each line. The value is a height spec, and it translates | |
1795 into a Lisp value as described above. However, in this case the | |
1796 numeric height value specifies the line spacing, rather than the line | |
1797 height. | |
1798 | |
102981
789bf99f58e7
* display.texi (Line Height): Emphasize that line-spacing only takes
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102975
diff
changeset
|
1799 On text-only terminals, the line spacing cannot be altered. |
789bf99f58e7
* display.texi (Line Height): Emphasize that line-spacing only takes
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102975
diff
changeset
|
1800 |
84060 | 1801 @node Faces |
1802 @section Faces | |
1803 @cindex faces | |
1804 | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1805 A @dfn{face} is a collection of graphical attributes for displaying |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1806 text: font family, foreground color, background color, optional |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1807 underlining, and so on. Faces control how buffer text is displayed, |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1808 and how some parts of the frame, such as the mode-line, are displayed. |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1809 @xref{Standard Faces,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for the list of |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1810 faces Emacs normally comes with. |
84060 | 1811 |
1812 @cindex face id | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1813 For most purposes, you refer to a face in Lisp programs using its |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1814 @dfn{face name}. This is either a string or (equivalently) a Lisp |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1815 symbol whose name is equal to that string. |
84060 | 1816 |
1817 @defun facep object | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1818 This function returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{object} is a Lisp |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1819 symbol or string that names a face. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}. |
84060 | 1820 @end defun |
1821 | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1822 Each face name is meaningful for all frames, and by default it has |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1823 the same meaning in all frames. But you can arrange to give a |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1824 particular face name a special meaning in one frame if you wish. |
84060 | 1825 |
1826 @menu | |
1827 * Defining Faces:: How to define a face with @code{defface}. | |
1828 * Face Attributes:: What is in a face? | |
1829 * Attribute Functions:: Functions to examine and set face attributes. | |
1830 * Displaying Faces:: How Emacs combines the faces specified for a character. | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
1831 * Face Remapping:: Remapping faces to alternative definitions. |
84060 | 1832 * Face Functions:: How to define and examine faces. |
1833 * Auto Faces:: Hook for automatic face assignment. | |
100990
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
1834 * Font Selection:: Finding the best available font for a face. |
84060 | 1835 * Font Lookup:: Looking up the names of available fonts |
1836 and information about them. | |
1837 * Fontsets:: A fontset is a collection of fonts | |
1838 that handle a range of character sets. | |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
1839 * Low-Level Font:: Lisp representation for character display fonts. |
84060 | 1840 @end menu |
1841 | |
1842 @node Defining Faces | |
1843 @subsection Defining Faces | |
1844 | |
1845 The way to define a new face is with @code{defface}. This creates a | |
1846 kind of customization item (@pxref{Customization}) which the user can | |
1847 customize using the Customization buffer (@pxref{Easy Customization,,, | |
1848 emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}). | |
1849 | |
98267
559b4f23d84b
(Defining Faces): Recommend against face variables.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
98185
diff
changeset
|
1850 People are sometimes tempted to create variables whose values specify |
559b4f23d84b
(Defining Faces): Recommend against face variables.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
98185
diff
changeset
|
1851 which faces to use (for example, Font-Lock does this). In the vast |
559b4f23d84b
(Defining Faces): Recommend against face variables.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
98185
diff
changeset
|
1852 majority of cases, this is not necessary, and simply using faces |
559b4f23d84b
(Defining Faces): Recommend against face variables.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
98185
diff
changeset
|
1853 directly is preferable. |
559b4f23d84b
(Defining Faces): Recommend against face variables.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
98185
diff
changeset
|
1854 |
84060 | 1855 @defmac defface face spec doc [keyword value]@dots{} |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1856 This declares @var{face} as a customizable face whose default |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1857 attributes are given by @var{spec}. You should not quote the symbol |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1858 @var{face}, and it should not end in @samp{-face} (that would be |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1859 redundant). The argument @var{doc} specifies the face documentation. |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1860 The keywords you can use in @code{defface} are the same as in |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1861 @code{defgroup} and @code{defcustom} (@pxref{Common Keywords}). |
84060 | 1862 |
1863 When @code{defface} executes, it defines the face according to | |
1864 @var{spec}, then uses any customizations that were read from the | |
1865 init file (@pxref{Init File}) to override that specification. | |
1866 | |
1867 When you evaluate a @code{defface} form with @kbd{C-M-x} in Emacs | |
1868 Lisp mode (@code{eval-defun}), a special feature of @code{eval-defun} | |
1869 overrides any customizations of the face. This way, the face reflects | |
1870 exactly what the @code{defface} says. | |
1871 | |
1872 The purpose of @var{spec} is to specify how the face should appear on | |
1873 different kinds of terminals. It should be an alist whose elements | |
1874 have the form @code{(@var{display} @var{atts})}. Each element's | |
1875 @sc{car}, @var{display}, specifies a class of terminals. (The first | |
1876 element, if its @sc{car} is @code{default}, is special---it specifies | |
1877 defaults for the remaining elements). The element's @sc{cadr}, | |
1878 @var{atts}, is a list of face attributes and their values; it | |
1879 specifies what the face should look like on that kind of terminal. | |
1880 The possible attributes are defined in the value of | |
1881 @code{custom-face-attributes}. | |
1882 | |
1883 The @var{display} part of an element of @var{spec} determines which | |
1884 frames the element matches. If more than one element of @var{spec} | |
1885 matches a given frame, the first element that matches is the one used | |
1886 for that frame. There are three possibilities for @var{display}: | |
1887 | |
1888 @table @asis | |
1889 @item @code{default} | |
1890 This element of @var{spec} doesn't match any frames; instead, it | |
1891 specifies defaults that apply to all frames. This kind of element, if | |
1892 used, must be the first element of @var{spec}. Each of the following | |
1893 elements can override any or all of these defaults. | |
1894 | |
1895 @item @code{t} | |
1896 This element of @var{spec} matches all frames. Therefore, any | |
1897 subsequent elements of @var{spec} are never used. Normally | |
1898 @code{t} is used in the last (or only) element of @var{spec}. | |
1899 | |
1900 @item a list | |
1901 If @var{display} is a list, each element should have the form | |
1902 @code{(@var{characteristic} @var{value}@dots{})}. Here | |
1903 @var{characteristic} specifies a way of classifying frames, and the | |
1904 @var{value}s are possible classifications which @var{display} should | |
1905 apply to. Here are the possible values of @var{characteristic}: | |
1906 | |
1907 @table @code | |
1908 @item type | |
1909 The kind of window system the frame uses---either @code{graphic} (any | |
1910 graphics-capable display), @code{x}, @code{pc} (for the MS-DOS console), | |
97043
9592c50233ab
Remove support for Mac Carbon.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
96470
diff
changeset
|
1911 @code{w32} (for MS Windows 9X/NT/2K/XP), or @code{tty} |
9592c50233ab
Remove support for Mac Carbon.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
96470
diff
changeset
|
1912 (a non-graphics-capable display). |
84060 | 1913 @xref{Window Systems, window-system}. |
1914 | |
1915 @item class | |
1916 What kinds of colors the frame supports---either @code{color}, | |
1917 @code{grayscale}, or @code{mono}. | |
1918 | |
1919 @item background | |
1920 The kind of background---either @code{light} or @code{dark}. | |
1921 | |
1922 @item min-colors | |
1923 An integer that represents the minimum number of colors the frame | |
1924 should support. This matches a frame if its | |
1925 @code{display-color-cells} value is at least the specified integer. | |
1926 | |
1927 @item supports | |
1928 Whether or not the frame can display the face attributes given in | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1929 @var{value}@dots{} (@pxref{Face Attributes}). @xref{Display Face |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1930 Attribute Testing}, for more information on exactly how this testing |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1931 is done. |
84060 | 1932 @end table |
1933 | |
1934 If an element of @var{display} specifies more than one @var{value} for a | |
1935 given @var{characteristic}, any of those values is acceptable. If | |
1936 @var{display} has more than one element, each element should specify a | |
1937 different @var{characteristic}; then @emph{each} characteristic of the | |
1938 frame must match one of the @var{value}s specified for it in | |
1939 @var{display}. | |
1940 @end table | |
1941 @end defmac | |
1942 | |
1943 Here's how the standard face @code{region} is defined: | |
1944 | |
1945 @example | |
1946 @group | |
1947 (defface region | |
1948 '((((class color) (min-colors 88) (background dark)) | |
1949 :background "blue3") | |
1950 @end group | |
1951 (((class color) (min-colors 88) (background light)) | |
1952 :background "lightgoldenrod2") | |
1953 (((class color) (min-colors 16) (background dark)) | |
1954 :background "blue3") | |
1955 (((class color) (min-colors 16) (background light)) | |
1956 :background "lightgoldenrod2") | |
1957 (((class color) (min-colors 8)) | |
1958 :background "blue" :foreground "white") | |
1959 (((type tty) (class mono)) | |
1960 :inverse-video t) | |
1961 (t :background "gray")) | |
1962 @group | |
1963 "Basic face for highlighting the region." | |
1964 :group 'basic-faces) | |
1965 @end group | |
1966 @end example | |
1967 | |
1968 Internally, @code{defface} uses the symbol property | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1969 @code{face-defface-spec} to record the specified face attributes. The |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1970 attributes saved by the user with the customization buffer are |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1971 recorded in the symbol property @code{saved-face}; the attributes |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1972 customized by the user for the current session, but not saved, are |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1973 recorded in the symbol property @code{customized-face}. The |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1974 documentation string is recorded in the symbol property |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1975 @code{face-documentation}. |
84060 | 1976 |
1977 @defopt frame-background-mode | |
1978 This option, if non-@code{nil}, specifies the background type to use for | |
1979 interpreting face definitions. If it is @code{dark}, then Emacs treats | |
1980 all frames as if they had a dark background, regardless of their actual | |
1981 background colors. If it is @code{light}, then Emacs treats all frames | |
1982 as if they had a light background. | |
1983 @end defopt | |
1984 | |
1985 @node Face Attributes | |
1986 @subsection Face Attributes | |
1987 @cindex face attributes | |
1988 | |
1989 The effect of using a face is determined by a fixed set of @dfn{face | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1990 attributes}. This table lists all the face attributes, their possible |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1991 values, and their effects. You can specify more than one face for a |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1992 given piece of text; Emacs merges the attributes of all the faces to |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1993 determine how to display the text. @xref{Displaying Faces}. |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1994 |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1995 In addition to the values given below, each face attribute can also |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1996 have the value @code{unspecified}. This special value means the face |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1997 doesn't specify that attribute. In face merging, when the first face |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1998 fails to specify a particular attribute, the next face gets a chance. |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
1999 However, the @code{default} face must specify all attributes. |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2000 |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2001 Some of these font attributes are meaningful only on certain kinds |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2002 of displays. If your display cannot handle a certain attribute, the |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2003 attribute is ignored. |
84060 | 2004 |
2005 @table @code | |
2006 @item :family | |
100990
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2007 Font family name or fontset name (a string). If you specify a font |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2008 family name, the wild-card characters @samp{*} and @samp{?} are |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2009 allowed. The function @code{font-family-list}, described below, |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2010 returns a list of available family names. @xref{Fontsets}, for |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2011 information about fontsets. |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2012 |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2013 @item :foundry |
100990
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2014 The name of the @dfn{font foundry} in which the font family specified |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2015 by the @code{:family} attribute is located (a string). The wild-card |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2016 characters @samp{*} and @samp{?} are allowed. |
84060 | 2017 |
2018 @item :width | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2019 Relative proportionate character width, also known as the character |
84060 | 2020 set width. This should be one of the symbols @code{ultra-condensed}, |
2021 @code{extra-condensed}, @code{condensed}, @code{semi-condensed}, | |
2022 @code{normal}, @code{semi-expanded}, @code{expanded}, | |
2023 @code{extra-expanded}, or @code{ultra-expanded}. | |
2024 | |
2025 @item :height | |
104288
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2026 The height of the font. In the simplest case, this is an integer in |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2027 units of 1/10 point. |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2028 |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2029 The value can also be a floating point number or a function, which |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2030 specifies the height relative to an @dfn{underlying face} (i.e., a |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2031 face that has a lower priority in the list described in |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2032 @ref{Displaying Faces}). If the value is a floating point number, |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2033 that specifies the amount by which to scale the height of the |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2034 underlying face. If the value is a function, that function is called |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2035 with one argument, the height of the underlying face, and returns the |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2036 height of the new face. If the function is passed an integer |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2037 argument, it must return an integer. |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2038 |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2039 The height of the default face must be specified using an integer; |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2040 floating point and function values are not allowed. |
84060 | 2041 |
2042 @item :weight | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2043 Font weight---one of the symbols (from densest to faintest) |
84060 | 2044 @code{ultra-bold}, @code{extra-bold}, @code{bold}, @code{semi-bold}, |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2045 @code{normal}, @code{semi-light}, @code{light}, @code{extra-light}, or |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2046 @code{ultra-light}. On text-only terminals that support |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2047 variable-brightness text, any weight greater than normal is displayed |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2048 as extra bright, and any weight less than normal is displayed as |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2049 half-bright. |
84060 | 2050 |
2051 @item :slant | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2052 Font slant---one of the symbols @code{italic}, @code{oblique}, |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2053 @code{normal}, @code{reverse-italic}, or @code{reverse-oblique}. On |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2054 text-only terminals that support variable-brightness text, slanted |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2055 text is displayed as half-bright. |
84060 | 2056 |
2057 @item :foreground | |
2058 Foreground color, a string. The value can be a system-defined color | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2059 name, or a hexadecimal color specification. @xref{Color Names}. On |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2060 black-and-white displays, certain shades of gray are implemented by |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2061 stipple patterns. |
84060 | 2062 |
2063 @item :background | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2064 Background color, a string. The value can be a system-defined color |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2065 name, or a hexadecimal color specification. @xref{Color Names}. |
84060 | 2066 |
2067 @item :underline | |
2068 Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color. If | |
2069 the value is @code{t}, underlining uses the foreground color of the | |
2070 face. If the value is a string, underlining uses that color. The | |
2071 value @code{nil} means do not underline. | |
2072 | |
2073 @item :overline | |
2074 Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color. | |
2075 The value is used like that of @code{:underline}. | |
2076 | |
2077 @item :strike-through | |
2078 Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what | |
2079 color. The value is used like that of @code{:underline}. | |
2080 | |
2081 @item :box | |
2082 Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its color, the | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2083 width of the box lines, and 3D appearance. Here are the possible |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2084 values of the @code{:box} attribute, and what they mean: |
84060 | 2085 |
2086 @table @asis | |
2087 @item @code{nil} | |
2088 Don't draw a box. | |
2089 | |
2090 @item @code{t} | |
2091 Draw a box with lines of width 1, in the foreground color. | |
2092 | |
2093 @item @var{color} | |
2094 Draw a box with lines of width 1, in color @var{color}. | |
2095 | |
2096 @item @code{(:line-width @var{width} :color @var{color} :style @var{style})} | |
2097 This way you can explicitly specify all aspects of the box. The value | |
2098 @var{width} specifies the width of the lines to draw; it defaults to 1. | |
2099 | |
2100 The value @var{color} specifies the color to draw with. The default is | |
2101 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background | |
2102 color of the face for 3D boxes. | |
2103 | |
2104 The value @var{style} specifies whether to draw a 3D box. If it is | |
2105 @code{released-button}, the box looks like a 3D button that is not being | |
2106 pressed. If it is @code{pressed-button}, the box looks like a 3D button | |
2107 that is being pressed. If it is @code{nil} or omitted, a plain 2D box | |
2108 is used. | |
2109 @end table | |
2110 | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2111 @item :inverse-video |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2112 Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video. The |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2113 value should be @code{t} (yes) or @code{nil} (no). |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2114 |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2115 @item :stipple |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2116 The background stipple, a bitmap. |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2117 |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2118 The value can be a string; that should be the name of a file containing |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2119 external-format X bitmap data. The file is found in the directories |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2120 listed in the variable @code{x-bitmap-file-path}. |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2121 |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2122 Alternatively, the value can specify the bitmap directly, with a list |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2123 of the form @code{(@var{width} @var{height} @var{data})}. Here, |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2124 @var{width} and @var{height} specify the size in pixels, and |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2125 @var{data} is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap, row by |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2126 row. Each row occupies @math{(@var{width} + 7) / 8} consecutive bytes |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2127 in the string (which should be a unibyte string for best results). |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2128 This means that each row always occupies at least one whole byte. |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2129 |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2130 If the value is @code{nil}, that means use no stipple pattern. |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2131 |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2132 Normally you do not need to set the stipple attribute, because it is |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2133 used automatically to handle certain shades of gray. |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2134 |
84060 | 2135 @item :font |
100990
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2136 The font used to display the face. Its value should be a font object. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2137 @xref{Font Selection}, for information about font objects. |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2138 |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2139 When specifying this attribute using @code{set-face-attribute} |
100990
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2140 (@pxref{Attribute Functions}), you may also supply a font spec, a font |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2141 entity, or a string. Emacs converts such values to an appropriate |
100990
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2142 font object, and stores that font object as the actual attribute |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2143 value. If you specify a string, the contents of the string should be |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2144 a font name (@pxref{Font X,, Font Specification Options, emacs, The |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2145 GNU Emacs Manual}); if the font name is an XLFD containing wildcards, |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2146 Emacs chooses the first font matching those wildcards. Specifying |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2147 this attribute also changes the values of the @code{:family}, |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2148 @code{:foundry}, @code{:width}, @code{:height}, @code{:weight}, and |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2149 @code{:slant} attributes. |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2150 |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2151 @item :inherit |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2152 The name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list of face |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2153 names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face like |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2154 an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying |
104288
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2155 faces (@pxref{Displaying Faces}). If a list of faces is used, |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2156 attributes from faces earlier in the list override those from later |
a21bb1c0cb0e
* display.texi (Face Attributes): Add xref to Displaying Faces for
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103820
diff
changeset
|
2157 faces. |
84060 | 2158 @end table |
2159 | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2160 For compatibility with Emacs 20, you can also specify values for two |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2161 ``fake'' face attributes: @code{:bold} and @code{:italic}. Their |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2162 values must be either @code{t} or @code{nil}; a value of |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2163 @code{unspecified} is not allowed. Setting @code{:bold} to @code{t} |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2164 is equivalent to setting the @code{:weight} attribute to @code{bold}, |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2165 and setting it to @code{nil} is equivalent to setting @code{:weight} |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2166 to @code{normal}. Setting @code{:italic} to @code{t} is equivalent to |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2167 setting the @code{:slant} attribute to @code{italic}, and setting it |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2168 to @code{nil} is equivalent to setting @code{:slant} to @code{normal}. |
84060 | 2169 |
100990
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2170 @defun font-family-list &optional frame |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2171 This function returns a list of available font family names. The |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2172 optional argument @var{frame} specifies the frame on which the text is |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2173 to be displayed; if it is @code{nil}, the selected frame is used. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2174 @end defun |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2175 |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2176 @defopt underline-minimum-offset |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
2177 This variable specifies the minimum distance between the baseline and |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
2178 the underline, in pixels, when displaying underlined text. |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2179 @end defopt |
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2180 |
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2181 @defopt x-bitmap-file-path |
84060 | 2182 This variable specifies a list of directories for searching |
2183 for bitmap files, for the @code{:stipple} attribute. | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2184 @end defopt |
84060 | 2185 |
2186 @defun bitmap-spec-p object | |
2187 This returns @code{t} if @var{object} is a valid bitmap specification, | |
2188 suitable for use with @code{:stipple} (see above). It returns | |
2189 @code{nil} otherwise. | |
2190 @end defun | |
2191 | |
2192 @node Attribute Functions | |
2193 @subsection Face Attribute Functions | |
2194 | |
2195 This section describes the functions for accessing and modifying the | |
2196 attributes of an existing face. | |
2197 | |
2198 @defun set-face-attribute face frame &rest arguments | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2199 This function sets one or more attributes of @var{face} for |
84060 | 2200 @var{frame}. The attributes you specify this way override whatever |
2201 the @code{defface} says. | |
2202 | |
2203 The extra arguments @var{arguments} specify the attributes to set, and | |
2204 the values for them. They should consist of alternating attribute names | |
2205 (such as @code{:family} or @code{:underline}) and corresponding values. | |
2206 Thus, | |
2207 | |
2208 @example | |
2209 (set-face-attribute 'foo nil | |
2210 :width 'extended | |
2211 :weight 'bold | |
2212 :underline "red") | |
2213 @end example | |
2214 | |
2215 @noindent | |
2216 sets the attributes @code{:width}, @code{:weight} and @code{:underline} | |
2217 to the corresponding values. | |
2218 | |
2219 If @var{frame} is @code{t}, this function sets the default attributes | |
2220 for new frames. Default attribute values specified this way override | |
2221 the @code{defface} for newly created frames. | |
2222 | |
2223 If @var{frame} is @code{nil}, this function sets the attributes for | |
2224 all existing frames, and the default for new frames. | |
2225 @end defun | |
2226 | |
2227 @defun face-attribute face attribute &optional frame inherit | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2228 This returns the value of the @var{attribute} attribute of @var{face} |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2229 on @var{frame}. If @var{frame} is @code{nil}, that means the selected |
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2230 frame (@pxref{Input Focus}). |
84060 | 2231 |
2232 If @var{frame} is @code{t}, this returns whatever new-frames default | |
2233 value you previously specified with @code{set-face-attribute} for the | |
2234 @var{attribute} attribute of @var{face}. If you have not specified | |
2235 one, it returns @code{nil}. | |
2236 | |
2237 If @var{inherit} is @code{nil}, only attributes directly defined by | |
2238 @var{face} are considered, so the return value may be | |
2239 @code{unspecified}, or a relative value. If @var{inherit} is | |
2240 non-@code{nil}, @var{face}'s definition of @var{attribute} is merged | |
2241 with the faces specified by its @code{:inherit} attribute; however the | |
2242 return value may still be @code{unspecified} or relative. If | |
2243 @var{inherit} is a face or a list of faces, then the result is further | |
2244 merged with that face (or faces), until it becomes specified and | |
2245 absolute. | |
2246 | |
2247 To ensure that the return value is always specified and absolute, use | |
2248 a value of @code{default} for @var{inherit}; this will resolve any | |
2249 unspecified or relative values by merging with the @code{default} face | |
2250 (which is always completely specified). | |
2251 | |
2252 For example, | |
2253 | |
2254 @example | |
2255 (face-attribute 'bold :weight) | |
2256 @result{} bold | |
2257 @end example | |
2258 @end defun | |
2259 | |
2260 @defun face-attribute-relative-p attribute value | |
2261 This function returns non-@code{nil} if @var{value}, when used as the | |
2262 value of the face attribute @var{attribute}, is relative. This means | |
2263 it would modify, rather than completely override, any value that comes | |
2264 from a subsequent face in the face list or that is inherited from | |
2265 another face. | |
2266 | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2267 @code{unspecified} is a relative value for all attributes. For |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2268 @code{:height}, floating point and function values are also relative. |
84060 | 2269 |
2270 For example: | |
2271 | |
2272 @example | |
2273 (face-attribute-relative-p :height 2.0) | |
2274 @result{} t | |
2275 @end example | |
2276 @end defun | |
2277 | |
98972
8860f1bf41c3
(Attribute Functions): Document `face-all-attributes'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98709
diff
changeset
|
2278 @defun face-all-attributes face &optional frame |
8860f1bf41c3
(Attribute Functions): Document `face-all-attributes'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98709
diff
changeset
|
2279 This function returns an alist of attributes of @var{face}. The |
8860f1bf41c3
(Attribute Functions): Document `face-all-attributes'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98709
diff
changeset
|
2280 elements of the result are name-value pairs of the form |
8860f1bf41c3
(Attribute Functions): Document `face-all-attributes'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98709
diff
changeset
|
2281 @w{@code{(@var{attr-name} . @var{attr-value})}}. Optional argument |
8860f1bf41c3
(Attribute Functions): Document `face-all-attributes'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98709
diff
changeset
|
2282 @var{frame} specifies the frame whose definition of @var{face} to |
8860f1bf41c3
(Attribute Functions): Document `face-all-attributes'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98709
diff
changeset
|
2283 return; if omitted or @code{nil}, the returned value describes the |
8860f1bf41c3
(Attribute Functions): Document `face-all-attributes'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98709
diff
changeset
|
2284 default attributes of @var{face} for newly created frames. |
8860f1bf41c3
(Attribute Functions): Document `face-all-attributes'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98709
diff
changeset
|
2285 @end defun |
8860f1bf41c3
(Attribute Functions): Document `face-all-attributes'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98709
diff
changeset
|
2286 |
84060 | 2287 @defun merge-face-attribute attribute value1 value2 |
2288 If @var{value1} is a relative value for the face attribute | |
2289 @var{attribute}, returns it merged with the underlying value | |
2290 @var{value2}; otherwise, if @var{value1} is an absolute value for the | |
2291 face attribute @var{attribute}, returns @var{value1} unchanged. | |
2292 @end defun | |
2293 | |
100949
91ffb924a3e5
(Faces): Don't discuss face id here. facep does
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100599
diff
changeset
|
2294 The following functions provide compatibility with Emacs 20 and |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2295 below. They work by calling @code{set-face-attribute}. Values of |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2296 @code{t} and @code{nil} for their @var{frame} argument are handled |
84060 | 2297 just like @code{set-face-attribute} and @code{face-attribute}. |
2298 | |
2299 @defun set-face-foreground face color &optional frame | |
2300 @defunx set-face-background face color &optional frame | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2301 These functions set the @code{:foreground} attribute (or |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2302 @code{:background} attribute, respectively) of @var{face} to |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2303 @var{color}. |
84060 | 2304 @end defun |
2305 | |
2306 @defun set-face-stipple face pattern &optional frame | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2307 This function sets the @code{:stipple} attribute of @var{face} to |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2308 @var{pattern}. |
84060 | 2309 @end defun |
2310 | |
2311 @defun set-face-font face font &optional frame | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2312 This function sets the @code{:font} attribute of @var{face} to |
84060 | 2313 @var{font}. |
2314 @end defun | |
2315 | |
2316 @defun set-face-bold-p face bold-p &optional frame | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2317 This function sets the @code{:weight} attribute of @var{face} to |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2318 @var{normal} if @var{bold-p} is @code{nil}, and to @var{bold} |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2319 otherwise. |
84060 | 2320 @end defun |
2321 | |
2322 @defun set-face-italic-p face italic-p &optional frame | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2323 This function sets the @code{:slant} attribute of @var{face} to |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2324 @var{normal} if @var{italic-p} is @code{nil}, and to @var{italic} |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2325 otherwise. |
84060 | 2326 @end defun |
2327 | |
2328 @defun set-face-underline-p face underline &optional frame | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2329 This function sets the @code{:underline} attribute of @var{face} to |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2330 @var{underline}. |
84060 | 2331 @end defun |
2332 | |
2333 @defun set-face-inverse-video-p face inverse-video-p &optional frame | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2334 This function sets the @code{:inverse-video} attribute of @var{face} |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2335 to @var{inverse-video-p}. |
84060 | 2336 @end defun |
2337 | |
2338 @defun invert-face face &optional frame | |
2339 This function swaps the foreground and background colors of face | |
2340 @var{face}. | |
2341 @end defun | |
2342 | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2343 The following functions examine the attributes of a face. If you |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2344 don't specify @var{frame}, they refer to the selected frame; @code{t} |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2345 refers to the default data for new frames. They return the symbol |
84060 | 2346 @code{unspecified} if the face doesn't define any value for that |
2347 attribute. | |
2348 | |
2349 @defun face-foreground face &optional frame inherit | |
2350 @defunx face-background face &optional frame inherit | |
2351 These functions return the foreground color (or background color, | |
2352 respectively) of face @var{face}, as a string. | |
2353 | |
2354 If @var{inherit} is @code{nil}, only a color directly defined by the face is | |
2355 returned. If @var{inherit} is non-@code{nil}, any faces specified by its | |
2356 @code{:inherit} attribute are considered as well, and if @var{inherit} | |
2357 is a face or a list of faces, then they are also considered, until a | |
2358 specified color is found. To ensure that the return value is always | |
2359 specified, use a value of @code{default} for @var{inherit}. | |
2360 @end defun | |
2361 | |
2362 @defun face-stipple face &optional frame inherit | |
2363 This function returns the name of the background stipple pattern of face | |
2364 @var{face}, or @code{nil} if it doesn't have one. | |
2365 | |
2366 If @var{inherit} is @code{nil}, only a stipple directly defined by the | |
2367 face is returned. If @var{inherit} is non-@code{nil}, any faces | |
2368 specified by its @code{:inherit} attribute are considered as well, and | |
2369 if @var{inherit} is a face or a list of faces, then they are also | |
2370 considered, until a specified stipple is found. To ensure that the | |
2371 return value is always specified, use a value of @code{default} for | |
2372 @var{inherit}. | |
2373 @end defun | |
2374 | |
2375 @defun face-font face &optional frame | |
2376 This function returns the name of the font of face @var{face}. | |
2377 @end defun | |
2378 | |
2379 @defun face-bold-p face &optional frame | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2380 This function returns a non-@code{nil} value if the @code{:weight} |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2381 attribute of @var{face} is bolder than normal (i.e., one of |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2382 @code{semi-bold}, @code{bold}, @code{extra-bold}, or |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2383 @code{ultra-bold}). Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}. |
84060 | 2384 @end defun |
2385 | |
2386 @defun face-italic-p face &optional frame | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2387 This function returns a non-@code{nil} value if the @code{:slant} |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2388 attribute of @var{face} is @code{italic} or @code{oblique}, and |
84060 | 2389 @code{nil} otherwise. |
2390 @end defun | |
2391 | |
2392 @defun face-underline-p face &optional frame | |
2393 This function returns the @code{:underline} attribute of face @var{face}. | |
2394 @end defun | |
2395 | |
2396 @defun face-inverse-video-p face &optional frame | |
2397 This function returns the @code{:inverse-video} attribute of face @var{face}. | |
2398 @end defun | |
2399 | |
2400 @node Displaying Faces | |
2401 @subsection Displaying Faces | |
2402 | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2403 Here is how Emacs determines the face to use for displaying any |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2404 given piece of text: |
84060 | 2405 |
2406 @itemize @bullet | |
2407 @item | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2408 If the text consists of a special glyph, the glyph can specify a |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2409 particular face. @xref{Glyphs}. |
84060 | 2410 |
2411 @item | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2412 If the text lies within an active region, Emacs highlights it using |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2413 the @code{region} face. @xref{Standard Faces,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2414 Manual}. |
84060 | 2415 |
2416 @item | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2417 If the text lies within an overlay with a non-@code{nil} @code{face} |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2418 property, Emacs applies the face or face attributes specified by that |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2419 property. If the overlay has a @code{mouse-face} property and the |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2420 mouse is ``near enough'' to the overlay, Emacs applies the face or |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2421 face attributes specified by the @code{mouse-face} property instead. |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2422 @xref{Overlay Properties}. |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2423 |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2424 When multiple overlays cover one character, an overlay with higher |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2425 priority overrides those with lower priority. @xref{Overlays}. |
84060 | 2426 |
2427 @item | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2428 If the text contains a @code{face} or @code{mouse-face} property, |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2429 Emacs applies the specified faces and face attributes. @xref{Special |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2430 Properties}. (This is how Font Lock mode faces are applied. |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2431 @xref{Font Lock Mode}.) |
84060 | 2432 |
2433 @item | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2434 If the text lies within the mode line of the selected window, Emacs |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2435 applies the @code{mode-line} face. For the mode line of a |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2436 non-selected window, Emacs applies the @code{mode-line-inactive} face. |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2437 For a header line, Emacs applies the @code{header-line} face. |
84060 | 2438 |
2439 @item | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2440 If any given attribute has not been specified during the preceding |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2441 steps, Emacs applies the attribute of the @code{default} face. |
84060 | 2442 @end itemize |
2443 | |
2444 If these various sources together specify more than one face for a | |
2445 particular character, Emacs merges the attributes of the various faces | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2446 specified. For each attribute, Emacs tries using the above order |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2447 (i.e., first the face of any special glyph; then the face for region |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2448 highlighting, if appropriate; then faces specified by overlays, then |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2449 faces specified by text properties, then the @code{mode-line} or |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2450 @code{mode-line-inactive} or @code{header-line} face, if appropriate, |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2451 and finally the @code{default} face). |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2452 |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2453 @node Face Remapping |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2454 @subsection Face Remapping |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2455 |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2456 The variable @code{face-remapping-alist} is used for buffer-local or |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2457 global changes in the appearance of a face. For instance, it can be |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2458 used to make the @code{default} face a variable-pitch face within a |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2459 particular buffer. |
84060 | 2460 |
95457
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2461 @defvar face-remapping-alist |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2462 An alist whose elements have the form @code{(@var{face} |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2463 @var{remapping...})}. This causes Emacs to display text using the |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2464 face @var{face} using @var{remapping...} instead of @var{face}'s |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2465 ordinary definition. @var{remapping...} may be any face specification |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2466 suitable for a @code{face} text property: either a face name, or a |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2467 property list of attribute/value pairs. @xref{Special Properties}. |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2468 |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2469 If @code{face-remapping-alist} is buffer-local, its local value takes |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2470 effect only within that buffer. |
95457
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2471 |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2472 Two points bear emphasizing: |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2473 |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2474 @enumerate |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2475 @item |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2476 The new definition @var{remapping...} is the complete |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2477 specification of how to display @var{face}---it entirely replaces, |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2478 rather than augmenting or modifying, the normal definition of that |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2479 face. |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2480 |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2481 @item |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2482 If @var{remapping...} recursively references the same face name |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2483 @var{face}, either directly remapping entry, or via the |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
2484 @code{:inherit} attribute of some other face in @var{remapping...}, |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
2485 then that reference uses the normal definition of @var{face} in the |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
2486 selected frame, instead of the ``remapped'' definition. |
95457
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2487 |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2488 For instance, if the @code{mode-line} face is remapped using this |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2489 entry in @code{face-remapping-alist}: |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2490 @example |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2491 (mode-line italic mode-line) |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2492 @end example |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2493 @noindent |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2494 then the new definition of the @code{mode-line} face inherits from the |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2495 @code{italic} face, and the @emph{normal} (non-remapped) definition of |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2496 @code{mode-line} face. |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2497 @end enumerate |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2498 @end defvar |
95457
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2499 |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2500 A typical use of the @code{face-remapping-alist} is to change a |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2501 buffer's @code{default} face; for example, the following changes a |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2502 buffer's @code{default} face to use the @code{variable-pitch} face, |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2503 with the height doubled: |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2504 |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2505 @example |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2506 (set (make-local-variable 'face-remapping-alist) |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2507 '((default variable-pitch :height 2.0))) |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2508 @end example |
415f68458e61
Implement face-remapping-alist feature
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
94197
diff
changeset
|
2509 |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2510 The following functions implement a higher-level interface to |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2511 @code{face-remapping-alist}, making it easier to use |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2512 ``cooperatively''. They are mainly intended for buffer-local use, and |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2513 so all make @code{face-remapping-alist} variable buffer-local as a |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2514 side-effect. They use entries in @code{face-remapping-alist} which |
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
2515 have the general form: |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2516 |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2517 @example |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2518 (@var{face} @var{relative_specs_1} @var{relative_specs_2} @var{...} @var{base_specs}) |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2519 @end example |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2520 |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
2521 Everything except @var{face} is a ``face spec'': a list of face names |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
2522 or face attribute-value pairs. All face specs are merged together, |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
2523 with earlier values taking precedence. |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2524 |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2525 The @var{relative_specs_}n values are ``relative specs'', and are |
95563
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2526 added by @code{face-remap-add-relative} (and removed by |
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2527 @code{face-remap-remove-relative}. These are intended for face |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2528 modifications (such as increasing the size). Typical users of these |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2529 relative specs would be minor modes. |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2530 |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2531 @var{base_specs} is the lowest-priority value, and by default is just the |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2532 face name, which causes the global definition of that face to be used. |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2533 |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2534 A non-default value of @var{base_specs} may also be set using |
95563
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2535 @code{face-remap-set-base}. Because this @emph{overwrites} the |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2536 default base-spec value (which inherits the global face definition), |
95563
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2537 it is up to the caller of @code{face-remap-set-base} to add such |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2538 inheritance if it is desired. A typical use of |
95563
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2539 @code{face-remap-set-base} would be a major mode adding a face |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2540 remappings, e.g., of the default face. |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2541 |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2542 |
95563
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2543 @defun face-remap-add-relative face &rest specs |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2544 This functions adds a face remapping entry of @var{face} to @var{specs} |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2545 in the current buffer. |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2546 |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2547 It returns a ``cookie'' which can be used to later delete the remapping with |
95563
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2548 @code{face-remap-remove-relative}. |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2549 |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2550 @var{specs} can be any value suitable for the @code{face} text |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2551 property, including a face name, a list of face names, or a |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2552 face-attribute property list. The attributes given by @var{specs} |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2553 will be merged with any other currently active face remappings of |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2554 @var{face}, and with the global definition of @var{face} (by default; |
95563
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2555 this may be changed using @code{face-remap-set-base}), with the most |
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2556 recently added relative remapping taking precedence. |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2557 @end defun |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2558 |
95563
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2559 @defun face-remap-remove-relative cookie |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2560 This function removes a face remapping previously added by |
95563
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2561 @code{face-remap-add-relative}. @var{cookie} should be a return value |
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2562 from that function. |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2563 @end defun |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2564 |
95563
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2565 @defun face-remap-set-base face &rest specs |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2566 This function sets the ``base remapping'' of @var{face} in the current |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2567 buffer to @var{specs}. If @var{specs} is empty, the default base |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2568 remapping is restored, which inherits from the global definition of |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2569 @var{face}; note that this is different from @var{specs} containing a |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2570 single value @code{nil}, which has the opposite result (the global |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2571 definition of @var{face} is ignored). |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2572 @end defun |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2573 |
95563
6d9c4248a579
Rename functions in lisp/face-remap.el
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95553
diff
changeset
|
2574 @defun face-remap-reset-base face |
95515
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2575 This function sets the ``base remapping'' of @var{face} to its default |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2576 value, which inherits from @var{face}'s global definition. |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2577 @end defun |
328f63bafded
Add lisp/face-remap.el and associated documentation
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
95457
diff
changeset
|
2578 |
100990
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2579 @node Face Functions |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2580 @subsection Functions for Working with Faces |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2581 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2582 Here are additional functions for creating and working with faces. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2583 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2584 @defun make-face name |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2585 This function defines a new face named @var{name}, initially with all |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2586 attributes @code{nil}. It does nothing if there is already a face named |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2587 @var{name}. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2588 @end defun |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2589 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2590 @defun face-list |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2591 This function returns a list of all defined face names. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2592 @end defun |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2593 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2594 @defun copy-face old-face new-name &optional frame new-frame |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2595 This function defines a face named @var{new-name} as a copy of the existing |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2596 face named @var{old-face}. It creates the face @var{new-name} if that |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2597 doesn't already exist. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2598 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2599 If the optional argument @var{frame} is given, this function applies |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2600 only to that frame. Otherwise it applies to each frame individually, |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2601 copying attributes from @var{old-face} in each frame to @var{new-face} |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2602 in the same frame. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2603 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2604 If the optional argument @var{new-frame} is given, then @code{copy-face} |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2605 copies the attributes of @var{old-face} in @var{frame} to @var{new-name} |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2606 in @var{new-frame}. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2607 @end defun |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2608 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2609 @defun face-id face |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2610 This function returns the @dfn{face number} of face @var{face}. This |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2611 is a number that uniquely identifies a face at low levels within |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2612 Emacs. It is seldom necessary to refer to a face by its face number. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2613 @end defun |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2614 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2615 @defun face-documentation face |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2616 This function returns the documentation string of face @var{face}, or |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2617 @code{nil} if none was specified for it. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2618 @end defun |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2619 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2620 @defun face-equal face1 face2 &optional frame |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2621 This returns @code{t} if the faces @var{face1} and @var{face2} have the |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2622 same attributes for display. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2623 @end defun |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2624 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2625 @defun face-differs-from-default-p face &optional frame |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2626 This returns non-@code{nil} if the face @var{face} displays |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2627 differently from the default face. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2628 @end defun |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2629 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2630 @cindex face alias |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2631 A @dfn{face alias} provides an equivalent name for a face. You can |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2632 define a face alias by giving the alias symbol the @code{face-alias} |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2633 property, with a value of the target face name. The following example |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2634 makes @code{modeline} an alias for the @code{mode-line} face. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2635 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2636 @example |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2637 (put 'modeline 'face-alias 'mode-line) |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2638 @end example |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2639 |
104766
b5e40c2f5b4d
(Face Functions): Mention define-obsolete-face-alias.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
104626
diff
changeset
|
2640 @defun define-obsolete-face-alias obsolete-face current-face &optional when |
b5e40c2f5b4d
(Face Functions): Mention define-obsolete-face-alias.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
104626
diff
changeset
|
2641 This function defines a face alias and marks it as obsolete, indicating |
b5e40c2f5b4d
(Face Functions): Mention define-obsolete-face-alias.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
104626
diff
changeset
|
2642 that it may be removed in future. The optional string @var{when} |
b5e40c2f5b4d
(Face Functions): Mention define-obsolete-face-alias.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
104626
diff
changeset
|
2643 indicates when the face was made obsolete (for example, a release number). |
b5e40c2f5b4d
(Face Functions): Mention define-obsolete-face-alias.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
104626
diff
changeset
|
2644 @end defun |
b5e40c2f5b4d
(Face Functions): Mention define-obsolete-face-alias.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
104626
diff
changeset
|
2645 |
100990
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2646 @node Auto Faces |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2647 @subsection Automatic Face Assignment |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2648 @cindex automatic face assignment |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2649 @cindex faces, automatic choice |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2650 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2651 This hook is used for automatically assigning faces to text in the |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2652 buffer. It is part of the implementation of Jit-Lock mode, used by |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2653 Font-Lock. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2654 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2655 @defvar fontification-functions |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2656 This variable holds a list of functions that are called by Emacs |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2657 redisplay as needed to assign faces automatically to text in the buffer. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2658 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2659 The functions are called in the order listed, with one argument, a |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2660 buffer position @var{pos}. Each function should attempt to assign faces |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2661 to the text in the current buffer starting at @var{pos}. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2662 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2663 Each function should record the faces they assign by setting the |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2664 @code{face} property. It should also add a non-@code{nil} |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2665 @code{fontified} property for all the text it has assigned faces to. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2666 That property tells redisplay that faces have been assigned to that text |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2667 already. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2668 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2669 It is probably a good idea for each function to do nothing if the |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2670 character after @var{pos} already has a non-@code{nil} @code{fontified} |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2671 property, but this is not required. If one function overrides the |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2672 assignments made by a previous one, the properties as they are |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2673 after the last function finishes are the ones that really matter. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2674 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2675 For efficiency, we recommend writing these functions so that they |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2676 usually assign faces to around 400 to 600 characters at each call. |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2677 @end defvar |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2678 |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2679 @node Font Selection |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2680 @subsection Font Selection |
100990
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2681 |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2682 Before Emacs can draw a character on a particular display, it must |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2683 select a @dfn{font} for that character@footnote{In this context, the |
80faf5dfb6cd
(Faces): Put Font Selection node after Auto Faces.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100978
diff
changeset
|
2684 term @dfn{font} has nothing to do with Font Lock (@pxref{Font Lock |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2685 Mode}).}. Normally, Emacs automatically chooses a font based on the |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2686 faces assigned to that character---specifically, the face attributes |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2687 @code{:family}, @code{:weight}, @code{:slant}, and @code{:width} |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2688 (@pxref{Face Attributes}). The choice of font also depends on the |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2689 character to be displayed; some fonts can only display a limited set |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2690 of characters. If no available font exactly fits the requirements, |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2691 Emacs looks for the @dfn{closest matching font}. The variables in |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2692 this section control how Emacs makes this selection. |
84060 | 2693 |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2694 @defopt face-font-family-alternatives |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2695 If a given family is specified but does not exist, this variable |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2696 specifies alternative font families to try. Each element should have |
84060 | 2697 this form: |
2698 | |
2699 @example | |
2700 (@var{family} @var{alternate-families}@dots{}) | |
2701 @end example | |
2702 | |
2703 If @var{family} is specified but not available, Emacs will try the other | |
2704 families given in @var{alternate-families}, one by one, until it finds a | |
2705 family that does exist. | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2706 @end defopt |
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2707 |
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2708 @defopt face-font-selection-order |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2709 If there is no font that exactly matches all desired face attributes |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2710 (@code{:width}, @code{:height}, @code{:weight}, and @code{:slant}), |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2711 this variable specifies the order in which these attributes should be |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2712 considered when selecting the closest matching font. The value should |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2713 be a list containing those four attribute symbols, in order of |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2714 decreasing importance. The default is @code{(:width :height :weight |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2715 :slant)}. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2716 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2717 Font selection first finds the best available matches for the first |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2718 attribute in the list; then, among the fonts which are best in that |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2719 way, it searches for the best matches in the second attribute, and so |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2720 on. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2721 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2722 The attributes @code{:weight} and @code{:width} have symbolic values in |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2723 a range centered around @code{normal}. Matches that are more extreme |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2724 (farther from @code{normal}) are somewhat preferred to matches that are |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2725 less extreme (closer to @code{normal}); this is designed to ensure that |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2726 non-normal faces contrast with normal ones, whenever possible. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2727 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2728 One example of a case where this variable makes a difference is when the |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2729 default font has no italic equivalent. With the default ordering, the |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2730 @code{italic} face will use a non-italic font that is similar to the |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2731 default one. But if you put @code{:slant} before @code{:height}, the |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2732 @code{italic} face will use an italic font, even if its height is not |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2733 quite right. |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2734 @end defopt |
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2735 |
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2736 @defopt face-font-registry-alternatives |
84060 | 2737 This variable lets you specify alternative font registries to try, if a |
2738 given registry is specified and doesn't exist. Each element should have | |
2739 this form: | |
2740 | |
2741 @example | |
2742 (@var{registry} @var{alternate-registries}@dots{}) | |
2743 @end example | |
2744 | |
2745 If @var{registry} is specified but not available, Emacs will try the | |
2746 other registries given in @var{alternate-registries}, one by one, | |
2747 until it finds a registry that does exist. | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2748 @end defopt |
84060 | 2749 |
2750 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts, but by default it does not use | |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2751 them. |
84060 | 2752 |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2753 @defopt scalable-fonts-allowed |
84060 | 2754 This variable controls which scalable fonts to use. A value of |
2755 @code{nil}, the default, means do not use scalable fonts. @code{t} | |
2756 means to use any scalable font that seems appropriate for the text. | |
2757 | |
2758 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. Then a | |
2759 scalable font is enabled for use if its name matches any regular | |
2760 expression in the list. For example, | |
2761 | |
2762 @example | |
2763 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$")) | |
2764 @end example | |
2765 | |
2766 @noindent | |
2767 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry @code{muleindian-2}. | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
2768 @end defopt |
84060 | 2769 |
2770 @defvar face-font-rescale-alist | |
2771 This variable specifies scaling for certain faces. Its value should | |
2772 be a list of elements of the form | |
2773 | |
2774 @example | |
2775 (@var{fontname-regexp} . @var{scale-factor}) | |
2776 @end example | |
2777 | |
2778 If @var{fontname-regexp} matches the font name that is about to be | |
2779 used, this says to choose a larger similar font according to the | |
2780 factor @var{scale-factor}. You would use this feature to normalize | |
2781 the font size if certain fonts are bigger or smaller than their | |
2782 nominal heights and widths would suggest. | |
2783 @end defvar | |
2784 | |
2785 @node Font Lookup | |
2786 @subsection Looking Up Fonts | |
2787 | |
101289
fb88ce222846
(Font Lookup): Document WIDTH argument of x-list-fonts.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
101140
diff
changeset
|
2788 @defun x-list-fonts name &optional reference-face frame maximum width |
84060 | 2789 This function returns a list of available font names that match |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2790 @var{name}. @var{name} should be a string containing a font name in |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2791 either the Fontconfig, GTK, or XLFD format (@pxref{Font X,, Font |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2792 Specification Options, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}). Within an XLFD |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2793 string, wildcard characters may be used: the @samp{*} character |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2794 matches any substring, and the @samp{?} character matches any single |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2795 character. Case is ignored when matching font names. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2796 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2797 If the optional arguments @var{reference-face} and @var{frame} are |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2798 specified, the returned list includes only fonts that are the same |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2799 size as @var{reference-face} (a face name) currently is on the frame |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2800 @var{frame}. |
84060 | 2801 |
2802 The optional argument @var{maximum} sets a limit on how many fonts to | |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2803 return. If it is non-@code{nil}, then the return value is truncated |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2804 after the first @var{maximum} matching fonts. Specifying a small |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2805 value for @var{maximum} can make this function much faster, in cases |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2806 where many fonts match the pattern. |
101289
fb88ce222846
(Font Lookup): Document WIDTH argument of x-list-fonts.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
101140
diff
changeset
|
2807 |
fb88ce222846
(Font Lookup): Document WIDTH argument of x-list-fonts.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
101140
diff
changeset
|
2808 The optional argument @var{width} specifies a desired font width. If |
fb88ce222846
(Font Lookup): Document WIDTH argument of x-list-fonts.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
101140
diff
changeset
|
2809 it is non-@code{nil}, the function only returns those fonts whose |
fb88ce222846
(Font Lookup): Document WIDTH argument of x-list-fonts.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
101140
diff
changeset
|
2810 characters are (on average) @var{width} times as wide as |
fb88ce222846
(Font Lookup): Document WIDTH argument of x-list-fonts.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
101140
diff
changeset
|
2811 @var{reference-face}. |
84060 | 2812 @end defun |
2813 | |
2814 @defun x-family-fonts &optional family frame | |
2815 This function returns a list describing the available fonts for family | |
2816 @var{family} on @var{frame}. If @var{family} is omitted or @code{nil}, | |
2817 this list applies to all families, and therefore, it contains all | |
2818 available fonts. Otherwise, @var{family} must be a string; it may | |
2819 contain the wildcards @samp{?} and @samp{*}. | |
2820 | |
2821 The list describes the display that @var{frame} is on; if @var{frame} is | |
2822 omitted or @code{nil}, it applies to the selected frame's display | |
2823 (@pxref{Input Focus}). | |
2824 | |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
2825 Each element in the list is a vector of the following form: |
84060 | 2826 |
2827 @example | |
2828 [@var{family} @var{width} @var{point-size} @var{weight} @var{slant} | |
2829 @var{fixed-p} @var{full} @var{registry-and-encoding}] | |
2830 @end example | |
2831 | |
2832 The first five elements correspond to face attributes; if you | |
2833 specify these attributes for a face, it will use this font. | |
2834 | |
2835 The last three elements give additional information about the font. | |
2836 @var{fixed-p} is non-@code{nil} if the font is fixed-pitch. | |
2837 @var{full} is the full name of the font, and | |
2838 @var{registry-and-encoding} is a string giving the registry and | |
2839 encoding of the font. | |
2840 @end defun | |
2841 | |
2842 @defvar font-list-limit | |
2843 This variable specifies maximum number of fonts to consider in font | |
2844 matching. The function @code{x-family-fonts} will not return more than | |
2845 that many fonts, and font selection will consider only that many fonts | |
2846 when searching a matching font for face attributes. The default is | |
2847 currently 100. | |
2848 @end defvar | |
2849 | |
2850 @node Fontsets | |
2851 @subsection Fontsets | |
2852 | |
2853 A @dfn{fontset} is a list of fonts, each assigned to a range of | |
2854 character codes. An individual font cannot display the whole range of | |
2855 characters that Emacs supports, but a fontset can. Fontsets have names, | |
2856 just as fonts do, and you can use a fontset name in place of a font name | |
2857 when you specify the ``font'' for a frame or a face. Here is | |
2858 information about defining a fontset under Lisp program control. | |
2859 | |
2860 @defun create-fontset-from-fontset-spec fontset-spec &optional style-variant-p noerror | |
2861 This function defines a new fontset according to the specification | |
2862 string @var{fontset-spec}. The string should have this format: | |
2863 | |
2864 @smallexample | |
95553
9145bbb09578
(Fontsets): Fix typos.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
95515
diff
changeset
|
2865 @var{fontpattern}, @r{[}@var{charset}:@var{font}@r{]@dots{}} |
84060 | 2866 @end smallexample |
2867 | |
2868 @noindent | |
2869 Whitespace characters before and after the commas are ignored. | |
2870 | |
2871 The first part of the string, @var{fontpattern}, should have the form of | |
2872 a standard X font name, except that the last two fields should be | |
2873 @samp{fontset-@var{alias}}. | |
2874 | |
2875 The new fontset has two names, one long and one short. The long name is | |
2876 @var{fontpattern} in its entirety. The short name is | |
2877 @samp{fontset-@var{alias}}. You can refer to the fontset by either | |
2878 name. If a fontset with the same name already exists, an error is | |
2879 signaled, unless @var{noerror} is non-@code{nil}, in which case this | |
2880 function does nothing. | |
2881 | |
2882 If optional argument @var{style-variant-p} is non-@code{nil}, that says | |
2883 to create bold, italic and bold-italic variants of the fontset as well. | |
2884 These variant fontsets do not have a short name, only a long one, which | |
2885 is made by altering @var{fontpattern} to indicate the bold or italic | |
2886 status. | |
2887 | |
2888 The specification string also says which fonts to use in the fontset. | |
2889 See below for the details. | |
2890 @end defun | |
2891 | |
2892 The construct @samp{@var{charset}:@var{font}} specifies which font to | |
2893 use (in this fontset) for one particular character set. Here, | |
2894 @var{charset} is the name of a character set, and @var{font} is the font | |
2895 to use for that character set. You can use this construct any number of | |
2896 times in the specification string. | |
2897 | |
2898 For the remaining character sets, those that you don't specify | |
2899 explicitly, Emacs chooses a font based on @var{fontpattern}: it replaces | |
2900 @samp{fontset-@var{alias}} with a value that names one character set. | |
2901 For the @acronym{ASCII} character set, @samp{fontset-@var{alias}} is replaced | |
2902 with @samp{ISO8859-1}. | |
2903 | |
2904 In addition, when several consecutive fields are wildcards, Emacs | |
2905 collapses them into a single wildcard. This is to prevent use of | |
2906 auto-scaled fonts. Fonts made by scaling larger fonts are not usable | |
2907 for editing, and scaling a smaller font is not useful because it is | |
2908 better to use the smaller font in its own size, which Emacs does. | |
2909 | |
2910 Thus if @var{fontpattern} is this, | |
2911 | |
2912 @example | |
2913 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24 | |
2914 @end example | |
2915 | |
2916 @noindent | |
2917 the font specification for @acronym{ASCII} characters would be this: | |
2918 | |
2919 @example | |
2920 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1 | |
2921 @end example | |
2922 | |
2923 @noindent | |
2924 and the font specification for Chinese GB2312 characters would be this: | |
2925 | |
2926 @example | |
2927 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-gb2312*-* | |
2928 @end example | |
2929 | |
2930 You may not have any Chinese font matching the above font | |
2931 specification. Most X distributions include only Chinese fonts that | |
2932 have @samp{song ti} or @samp{fangsong ti} in the @var{family} field. In | |
2933 such a case, @samp{Fontset-@var{n}} can be specified as below: | |
2934 | |
2935 @smallexample | |
2936 Emacs.Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24,\ | |
2937 chinese-gb2312:-*-*-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-gb2312*-* | |
2938 @end smallexample | |
2939 | |
2940 @noindent | |
2941 Then, the font specifications for all but Chinese GB2312 characters have | |
2942 @samp{fixed} in the @var{family} field, and the font specification for | |
2943 Chinese GB2312 characters has a wild card @samp{*} in the @var{family} | |
2944 field. | |
2945 | |
102515
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2946 @defun set-fontset-font name character font-spec &optional frame add |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2947 This function modifies the existing fontset @var{name} to use the font |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2948 matching with @var{font-spec} for the character @var{character}. |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2949 |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2950 If @var{name} is @code{nil}, this function modifies the fontset of the |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2951 selected frame or that of @var{frame} if @var{frame} is not |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2952 @code{nil}. |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2953 |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2954 If @var{name} is @code{t}, this function modifies the default |
84060 | 2955 fontset, whose short name is @samp{fontset-default}. |
2956 | |
2957 @var{character} may be a cons; @code{(@var{from} . @var{to})}, where | |
98709
c5da883d1e87
(Fontsets): Don't mention generic characters.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98267
diff
changeset
|
2958 @var{from} and @var{to} are character codepoints. In that case, use |
102515
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2959 @var{font-spec} for all characters in the range @var{from} and @var{to} |
84060 | 2960 (inclusive). |
2961 | |
2962 @var{character} may be a charset. In that case, use | |
102515
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2963 @var{font-spec} for all character in the charsets. |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2964 |
104570 | 2965 @var{character} may be a script name. In that case, use |
102515
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2966 @var{font-spec} for all character in the charsets. |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2967 |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2968 @var{font-spec} may be a cons; @code{(@var{family} . @var{registry})}, |
84060 | 2969 where @var{family} is a family name of a font (possibly including a |
2970 foundry name at the head), @var{registry} is a registry name of a font | |
2971 (possibly including an encoding name at the tail). | |
2972 | |
102515
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2973 @var{font-spec} may be a font name string. |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2974 |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2975 The optional argument @var{add}, if non-@code{nil}, specifies how to |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2976 add @var{font-spec} to the font specifications previously set. If it |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2977 is @code{prepend}, @var{font-spec} is prepended. If it is |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2978 @code{append}, @var{font-spec} is appended. By default, |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2979 @var{font-spec} overrides the previous settings. |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2980 |
84060 | 2981 For instance, this changes the default fontset to use a font of which |
102515
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2982 family name is @samp{Kochi Gothic} for all characters belonging to |
84060 | 2983 the charset @code{japanese-jisx0208}. |
2984 | |
2985 @smallexample | |
102515
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2986 (set-fontset-font t 'japanese-jisx0208 |
34182d9c3399
(Fontsets): Update the description.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
102409
diff
changeset
|
2987 (font-spec :family "Kochi Gothic")) |
84060 | 2988 @end smallexample |
2989 @end defun | |
2990 | |
2991 @defun char-displayable-p char | |
2992 This function returns @code{t} if Emacs ought to be able to display | |
2993 @var{char}. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has a | |
2994 font to display the character set that @var{char} belongs to. | |
2995 | |
2996 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset | |
2997 does that, this function's value may not be accurate. | |
2998 @end defun | |
2999 | |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3000 @node Low-Level Font |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3001 @subsection Low-Level Font Representation |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3002 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3003 Normally, it is not necessary to manipulate fonts directly. In case |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3004 you need to do so, this section explains how. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3005 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3006 In Emacs Lisp, fonts are represented using three different Lisp |
101140
d4a656ae8ace
* display.texi (Low-Level Font): Fix typo.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
101069
diff
changeset
|
3007 object types: @dfn{font objects}, @dfn{font specs}, and @dfn{font |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3008 entities}. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3009 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3010 @defun fontp object &optional type |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3011 Return @code{t} if @var{object} is a font object, font spec, or font |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3012 entity. Otherwise, return @code{nil}. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3013 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3014 The optional argument @var{type}, if non-@code{nil}, determines the |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3015 exact type of Lisp object to check for. In that case, @var{type} |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3016 should be one of @code{font-object}, @code{font-spec}, or |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3017 @code{font-entity}. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3018 @end defun |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3019 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3020 A font object is a Lisp object that represents a font that Emacs has |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3021 @dfn{opened}. Font objects cannot be modified in Lisp, but they can |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
3022 be inspected. |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3023 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3024 @defun font-at position &optional window string |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3025 Return the font object that is being used to display the character at |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3026 position @var{position} in the window @var{window}. If @var{window} |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3027 is @code{nil}, it defaults to the selected window. If @var{string} is |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3028 @code{nil}, @var{position} specifies a position in the current buffer; |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3029 otherwise, @var{string} should be a string, and @var{position} |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3030 specifies a position in that string. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3031 @end defun |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3032 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3033 A font spec is a Lisp object that contains a set of specifications |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3034 that can be used to find a font. More than one font may match the |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3035 specifications in a font spec. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3036 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3037 @defun font-spec &rest arguments |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3038 Return a new font spec using the specifications in @var{arguments}, |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3039 which should come in @code{property}-@code{value} pairs. The possible |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3040 specifications are as follows: |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3041 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3042 @table @code |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3043 @item :name |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3044 The font name (a string), in either XLFD, Fontconfig, or GTK format. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3045 @xref{Font X,, Font Specification Options, emacs, The GNU Emacs |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3046 Manual}. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3047 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3048 @item :family |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3049 @itemx :foundry |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3050 @itemx :weight |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3051 @itemx :slant |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3052 @itemx :width |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3053 These have the same meanings as the face attributes of the same name. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3054 @xref{Face Attributes}. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3055 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3056 @item :size |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3057 The font size---either a non-negative integer that specifies the pixel |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3058 size, or a floating point number that specifies the point size. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3059 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3060 @item :adstyle |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3061 Additional typographic style information for the font, such as |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3062 @samp{sans}. The value should be a string or a symbol. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3063 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3064 @item :registry |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3065 The charset registry and encoding of the font, such as |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3066 @samp{iso8859-1}. The value should be a string or a symbol. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3067 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3068 @item :script |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3069 The script that the font must support (a symbol). |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3070 @end table |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3071 @end defun |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3072 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3073 @defun font-put font-spec property value |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3074 Set the font property @var{property} in the font-spec @var{font-spec} |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3075 to @var{value}. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3076 @end defun |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3077 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3078 A font entity is a reference to a font that need not be open. Its |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3079 properties are intermediate between a font object and a font spec: |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3080 like a font object, and unlike a font spec, it refers to a single, |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3081 specific font. Unlike a font object, creating a font entity does not |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3082 load the contents of that font into computer memory. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3083 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3084 @defun find-font font-spec &optional frame |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3085 This function returns a font entity that best matches the font spec |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3086 @var{font-spec} on frame @var{frame}. If @var{frame} is @code{nil}, |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3087 it defaults to the selected frame. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3088 @end defun |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3089 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3090 @defun list-fonts font-spec &optional frame num prefer |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3091 This function returns a list of all font entities that match the font |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3092 spec @var{font-spec}. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3093 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3094 The optional argument @var{frame}, if non-@code{nil}, specifies the |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3095 frame on which the fonts are to be displayed. The optional argument |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3096 @var{num}, if non-@code{nil}, should be an integer that specifies the |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3097 maximum length of the returned list. The optional argument |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3098 @var{prefer}, if non-@code{nil}, should be another font spec, which is |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3099 used to control the order of the returned list; the returned font |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3100 entities are sorted in order of decreasing ``closeness'' to that font |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3101 spec. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3102 @end defun |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3103 |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
3104 If you call @code{set-face-attribute} and pass a font spec, font |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
3105 entity, or font name string as the value of the @code{:font} |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
3106 attribute, Emacs opens the best ``matching'' font that is available |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
3107 for display. It then stores the corresponding font object as the |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
3108 actual value of the @code{:font} attribute for that face. |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
3109 |
101033
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3110 The following functions can be used to obtain information about a |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3111 font. For these functions, the @var{font} argument can be a font |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3112 object, a font entity, or a font spec. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3113 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3114 @defun font-get font property |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3115 This function returns the value of the font property @var{property} |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3116 for @var{font}. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3117 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3118 If @var{font} is a font spec and the font spec does not specify |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3119 @var{property}, the return value is @code{nil}. If @var{font} is a |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3120 font object or font entity, the value for the @var{:script} property |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3121 may be a list of scripts supported by the font. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3122 @end defun |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3123 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3124 @defun font-face-attributes font &optional frame |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3125 This function returns a list of face attributes corresponding to |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3126 @var{font}. The optional argument @var{frame} specifies the frame on |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3127 which the font is to be displayed. If it is @code{nil}, the selected |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3128 frame is used. The return value has the form |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3129 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3130 @smallexample |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3131 (:family @var{family} :height @var{height} :weight @var{weight} |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3132 :slant @var{slant} :width @var{width}) |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3133 @end smallexample |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3134 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3135 where the values of @var{family}, @var{height}, @var{weight}, |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3136 @var{slant}, and @var{width} are face attribute values. Some of these |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3137 key-attribute pairs may be omitted from the list if they are not |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3138 specified by @var{font}. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3139 @end defun |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3140 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3141 @defun font-xlfd-name font &optional fold-wildcards |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3142 This function returns the XLFD (X Logical Font Descriptor), a string, |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3143 matching @var{font}. @xref{Font X,, Font Specification Options, |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3144 emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for information about XLFDs. If the |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3145 name is too long for an XLFD (which can contain at most 255 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3146 characters), the function returns @code{nil}. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3147 |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3148 If the optional argument @var{fold-wildcards} is non-@code{nil}, |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3149 consecutive wildcards in the XLFD are folded into one. |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3150 @end defun |
652cf1b0fd5a
(Font Lookup): Remove obsolete function
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100990
diff
changeset
|
3151 |
84060 | 3152 @node Fringes |
3153 @section Fringes | |
3154 @cindex fringes | |
3155 | |
3156 The @dfn{fringes} of a window are thin vertical strips down the | |
3157 sides that are used for displaying bitmaps that indicate truncation, | |
3158 continuation, horizontal scrolling, and the overlay arrow. | |
3159 | |
3160 @menu | |
3161 * Fringe Size/Pos:: Specifying where to put the window fringes. | |
3162 * Fringe Indicators:: Displaying indicator icons in the window fringes. | |
3163 * Fringe Cursors:: Displaying cursors in the right fringe. | |
3164 * Fringe Bitmaps:: Specifying bitmaps for fringe indicators. | |
3165 * Customizing Bitmaps:: Specifying your own bitmaps to use in the fringes. | |
3166 * Overlay Arrow:: Display of an arrow to indicate position. | |
3167 @end menu | |
3168 | |
3169 @node Fringe Size/Pos | |
3170 @subsection Fringe Size and Position | |
3171 | |
3172 The following buffer-local variables control the position and width | |
3173 of the window fringes. | |
3174 | |
3175 @defvar fringes-outside-margins | |
3176 The fringes normally appear between the display margins and the window | |
3177 text. If the value is non-@code{nil}, they appear outside the display | |
3178 margins. @xref{Display Margins}. | |
3179 @end defvar | |
3180 | |
3181 @defvar left-fringe-width | |
3182 This variable, if non-@code{nil}, specifies the width of the left | |
3183 fringe in pixels. A value of @code{nil} means to use the left fringe | |
3184 width from the window's frame. | |
3185 @end defvar | |
3186 | |
3187 @defvar right-fringe-width | |
3188 This variable, if non-@code{nil}, specifies the width of the right | |
3189 fringe in pixels. A value of @code{nil} means to use the right fringe | |
3190 width from the window's frame. | |
3191 @end defvar | |
3192 | |
3193 The values of these variables take effect when you display the | |
3194 buffer in a window. If you change them while the buffer is visible, | |
3195 you can call @code{set-window-buffer} to display it once again in the | |
3196 same window, to make the changes take effect. | |
3197 | |
3198 @defun set-window-fringes window left &optional right outside-margins | |
3199 This function sets the fringe widths of window @var{window}. | |
3200 If @var{window} is @code{nil}, the selected window is used. | |
3201 | |
3202 The argument @var{left} specifies the width in pixels of the left | |
3203 fringe, and likewise @var{right} for the right fringe. A value of | |
3204 @code{nil} for either one stands for the default width. If | |
3205 @var{outside-margins} is non-@code{nil}, that specifies that fringes | |
3206 should appear outside of the display margins. | |
3207 @end defun | |
3208 | |
3209 @defun window-fringes &optional window | |
3210 This function returns information about the fringes of a window | |
3211 @var{window}. If @var{window} is omitted or @code{nil}, the selected | |
3212 window is used. The value has the form @code{(@var{left-width} | |
3213 @var{right-width} @var{outside-margins})}. | |
3214 @end defun | |
3215 | |
3216 | |
3217 @node Fringe Indicators | |
3218 @subsection Fringe Indicators | |
3219 @cindex fringe indicators | |
3220 @cindex indicators, fringe | |
3221 | |
3222 The @dfn{fringe indicators} are tiny icons Emacs displays in the | |
3223 window fringe (on a graphic display) to indicate truncated or | |
3224 continued lines, buffer boundaries, overlay arrow, etc. | |
3225 | |
3226 @defopt indicate-empty-lines | |
3227 @cindex fringes, and empty line indication | |
3228 When this is non-@code{nil}, Emacs displays a special glyph in the | |
3229 fringe of each empty line at the end of the buffer, on graphical | |
3230 displays. @xref{Fringes}. This variable is automatically | |
3231 buffer-local in every buffer. | |
3232 @end defopt | |
3233 | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
3234 @defopt indicate-buffer-boundaries |
84060 | 3235 This buffer-local variable controls how the buffer boundaries and |
3236 window scrolling are indicated in the window fringes. | |
3237 | |
3238 Emacs can indicate the buffer boundaries---that is, the first and last | |
3239 line in the buffer---with angle icons when they appear on the screen. | |
3240 In addition, Emacs can display an up-arrow in the fringe to show | |
3241 that there is text above the screen, and a down-arrow to show | |
3242 there is text below the screen. | |
3243 | |
3244 There are three kinds of basic values: | |
3245 | |
3246 @table @asis | |
3247 @item @code{nil} | |
3248 Don't display any of these fringe icons. | |
3249 @item @code{left} | |
3250 Display the angle icons and arrows in the left fringe. | |
3251 @item @code{right} | |
3252 Display the angle icons and arrows in the right fringe. | |
3253 @item any non-alist | |
3254 Display the angle icons in the left fringe | |
3255 and don't display the arrows. | |
3256 @end table | |
3257 | |
3258 Otherwise the value should be an alist that specifies which fringe | |
3259 indicators to display and where. Each element of the alist should | |
3260 have the form @code{(@var{indicator} . @var{position})}. Here, | |
3261 @var{indicator} is one of @code{top}, @code{bottom}, @code{up}, | |
3262 @code{down}, and @code{t} (which covers all the icons not yet | |
3263 specified), while @var{position} is one of @code{left}, @code{right} | |
3264 and @code{nil}. | |
3265 | |
3266 For example, @code{((top . left) (t . right))} places the top angle | |
3267 bitmap in left fringe, and the bottom angle bitmap as well as both | |
3268 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show the angle bitmaps in the left | |
3269 fringe, and no arrow bitmaps, use @code{((top . left) (bottom . left))}. | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
3270 @end defopt |
84060 | 3271 |
3272 @defvar fringe-indicator-alist | |
3273 This buffer-local variable specifies the mapping from logical fringe | |
3274 indicators to the actual bitmaps displayed in the window fringes. | |
3275 | |
3276 These symbols identify the logical fringe indicators: | |
3277 | |
3278 @table @asis | |
3279 @item Truncation and continuation line indicators: | |
3280 @code{truncation}, @code{continuation}. | |
3281 | |
3282 @item Buffer position indicators: | |
3283 @code{up}, @code{down}, | |
3284 @code{top}, @code{bottom}, | |
3285 @code{top-bottom}. | |
3286 | |
3287 @item Empty line indicator: | |
3288 @code{empty-line}. | |
3289 | |
3290 @item Overlay arrow indicator: | |
3291 @code{overlay-arrow}. | |
3292 | |
3293 @item Unknown bitmap indicator: | |
3294 @code{unknown}. | |
3295 @end table | |
3296 | |
3297 The value is an alist where each element @code{(@var{indicator} . @var{bitmaps})} | |
3298 specifies the fringe bitmaps used to display a specific logical | |
3299 fringe indicator. | |
3300 | |
3301 Here, @var{indicator} specifies the logical indicator type, and | |
3302 @var{bitmaps} is list of symbols @code{(@var{left} @var{right} | |
3303 [@var{left1} @var{right1}])} which specifies the actual bitmap shown | |
3304 in the left or right fringe for the logical indicator. | |
3305 | |
3306 The @var{left} and @var{right} symbols specify the bitmaps shown in | |
3307 the left and/or right fringe for the specific indicator. The | |
3308 @var{left1} or @var{right1} bitmaps are used only for the `bottom' and | |
3309 `top-bottom indicators when the last (only) line in has no final | |
3310 newline. Alternatively, @var{bitmaps} may be a single symbol which is | |
3311 used in both left and right fringes. | |
3312 | |
3313 When @code{fringe-indicator-alist} has a buffer-local value, and there | |
3314 is no bitmap defined for a logical indicator, or the bitmap is | |
104626
caa79498564a
* subr.el (default-mode-line-format, default-header-line-format)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104570
diff
changeset
|
3315 @code{t}, the corresponding value from the default value of |
caa79498564a
* subr.el (default-mode-line-format, default-header-line-format)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104570
diff
changeset
|
3316 @code{fringe-indicator-alist} is used. |
84060 | 3317 |
3318 To completely hide a specific indicator, set the bitmap to @code{nil}. | |
3319 @end defvar | |
3320 | |
3321 Standard fringe bitmaps for indicators: | |
3322 @example | |
3323 left-arrow right-arrow up-arrow down-arrow | |
3324 left-curly-arrow right-curly-arrow | |
3325 left-triangle right-triangle | |
3326 top-left-angle top-right-angle | |
3327 bottom-left-angle bottom-right-angle | |
3328 left-bracket right-bracket | |
3329 filled-rectangle hollow-rectangle | |
3330 filled-square hollow-square | |
3331 vertical-bar horizontal-bar | |
3332 empty-line question-mark | |
3333 @end example | |
3334 | |
3335 @node Fringe Cursors | |
3336 @subsection Fringe Cursors | |
3337 @cindex fringe cursors | |
3338 @cindex cursor, fringe | |
3339 | |
3340 When a line is exactly as wide as the window, Emacs displays the | |
3341 cursor in the right fringe instead of using two lines. Different | |
3342 bitmaps are used to represent the cursor in the fringe depending on | |
3343 the current buffer's cursor type. | |
3344 | |
3345 @table @asis | |
3346 @item Logical cursor types: | |
3347 @code{box} , @code{hollow}, @code{bar}, | |
3348 @code{hbar}, @code{hollow-small}. | |
3349 @end table | |
3350 | |
3351 The @code{hollow-small} type is used instead of @code{hollow} when the | |
3352 normal @code{hollow-rectangle} bitmap is too tall to fit on a specific | |
3353 display line. | |
3354 | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
3355 @defopt overflow-newline-into-fringe |
84060 | 3356 If this is non-@code{nil}, lines exactly as wide as the window (not |
3357 counting the final newline character) are not continued. Instead, | |
3358 when point is at the end of the line, the cursor appears in the right | |
3359 fringe. | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
3360 @end defopt |
84060 | 3361 |
3362 @defvar fringe-cursor-alist | |
3363 This variable specifies the mapping from logical cursor type to the | |
3364 actual fringe bitmaps displayed in the right fringe. The value is an | |
3365 alist where each element @code{(@var{cursor} . @var{bitmap})} specifies | |
3366 the fringe bitmaps used to display a specific logical cursor type in | |
3367 the fringe. Here, @var{cursor} specifies the logical cursor type and | |
3368 @var{bitmap} is a symbol specifying the fringe bitmap to be displayed | |
3369 for that logical cursor type. | |
3370 | |
3371 When @code{fringe-cursor-alist} has a buffer-local value, and there is | |
3372 no bitmap defined for a cursor type, the corresponding value from the | |
104626
caa79498564a
* subr.el (default-mode-line-format, default-header-line-format)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104570
diff
changeset
|
3373 default value of @code{fringes-indicator-alist} is used. |
84060 | 3374 @end defvar |
3375 | |
3376 Standard bitmaps for displaying the cursor in right fringe: | |
3377 @example | |
3378 filled-rectangle hollow-rectangle filled-square hollow-square | |
3379 vertical-bar horizontal-bar | |
3380 @end example | |
3381 | |
3382 | |
3383 @node Fringe Bitmaps | |
3384 @subsection Fringe Bitmaps | |
3385 @cindex fringe bitmaps | |
3386 @cindex bitmaps, fringe | |
3387 | |
3388 The @dfn{fringe bitmaps} are the actual bitmaps which represent the | |
3389 logical fringe indicators for truncated or continued lines, buffer | |
3390 boundaries, overlay arrow, etc. Fringe bitmap symbols have their own | |
3391 name space. The fringe bitmaps are shared by all frames and windows. | |
3392 You can redefine the built-in fringe bitmaps, and you can define new | |
3393 fringe bitmaps. | |
3394 | |
3395 The way to display a bitmap in the left or right fringes for a given | |
3396 line in a window is by specifying the @code{display} property for one | |
3397 of the characters that appears in it. Use a display specification of | |
3398 the form @code{(left-fringe @var{bitmap} [@var{face}])} or | |
3399 @code{(right-fringe @var{bitmap} [@var{face}])} (@pxref{Display | |
3400 Property}). Here, @var{bitmap} is a symbol identifying the bitmap you | |
3401 want, and @var{face} (which is optional) is the name of the face whose | |
3402 colors should be used for displaying the bitmap, instead of the | |
3403 default @code{fringe} face. @var{face} is automatically merged with | |
3404 the @code{fringe} face, so normally @var{face} need only specify the | |
3405 foreground color for the bitmap. | |
3406 | |
3407 @defun fringe-bitmaps-at-pos &optional pos window | |
3408 This function returns the fringe bitmaps of the display line | |
3409 containing position @var{pos} in window @var{window}. The return | |
3410 value has the form @code{(@var{left} @var{right} @var{ov})}, where @var{left} | |
3411 is the symbol for the fringe bitmap in the left fringe (or @code{nil} | |
3412 if no bitmap), @var{right} is similar for the right fringe, and @var{ov} | |
3413 is non-@code{nil} if there is an overlay arrow in the left fringe. | |
3414 | |
3415 The value is @code{nil} if @var{pos} is not visible in @var{window}. | |
3416 If @var{window} is @code{nil}, that stands for the selected window. | |
3417 If @var{pos} is @code{nil}, that stands for the value of point in | |
3418 @var{window}. | |
3419 @end defun | |
3420 | |
3421 @node Customizing Bitmaps | |
3422 @subsection Customizing Fringe Bitmaps | |
3423 | |
3424 @defun define-fringe-bitmap bitmap bits &optional height width align | |
3425 This function defines the symbol @var{bitmap} as a new fringe bitmap, | |
3426 or replaces an existing bitmap with that name. | |
3427 | |
3428 The argument @var{bits} specifies the image to use. It should be | |
3429 either a string or a vector of integers, where each element (an | |
3430 integer) corresponds to one row of the bitmap. Each bit of an integer | |
3431 corresponds to one pixel of the bitmap, where the low bit corresponds | |
3432 to the rightmost pixel of the bitmap. | |
3433 | |
3434 The height is normally the length of @var{bits}. However, you | |
3435 can specify a different height with non-@code{nil} @var{height}. The width | |
3436 is normally 8, but you can specify a different width with non-@code{nil} | |
3437 @var{width}. The width must be an integer between 1 and 16. | |
3438 | |
3439 The argument @var{align} specifies the positioning of the bitmap | |
3440 relative to the range of rows where it is used; the default is to | |
3441 center the bitmap. The allowed values are @code{top}, @code{center}, | |
3442 or @code{bottom}. | |
3443 | |
3444 The @var{align} argument may also be a list @code{(@var{align} | |
3445 @var{periodic})} where @var{align} is interpreted as described above. | |
3446 If @var{periodic} is non-@code{nil}, it specifies that the rows in | |
3447 @code{bits} should be repeated enough times to reach the specified | |
3448 height. | |
3449 @end defun | |
3450 | |
3451 @defun destroy-fringe-bitmap bitmap | |
3452 This function destroy the fringe bitmap identified by @var{bitmap}. | |
3453 If @var{bitmap} identifies a standard fringe bitmap, it actually | |
3454 restores the standard definition of that bitmap, instead of | |
3455 eliminating it entirely. | |
3456 @end defun | |
3457 | |
3458 @defun set-fringe-bitmap-face bitmap &optional face | |
3459 This sets the face for the fringe bitmap @var{bitmap} to @var{face}. | |
3460 If @var{face} is @code{nil}, it selects the @code{fringe} face. The | |
3461 bitmap's face controls the color to draw it in. | |
3462 | |
3463 @var{face} is merged with the @code{fringe} face, so normally | |
3464 @var{face} should specify only the foreground color. | |
3465 @end defun | |
3466 | |
3467 @node Overlay Arrow | |
3468 @subsection The Overlay Arrow | |
3469 @c @cindex overlay arrow Duplicates variable names | |
3470 | |
3471 The @dfn{overlay arrow} is useful for directing the user's attention | |
3472 to a particular line in a buffer. For example, in the modes used for | |
3473 interface to debuggers, the overlay arrow indicates the line of code | |
3474 about to be executed. This feature has nothing to do with | |
3475 @dfn{overlays} (@pxref{Overlays}). | |
3476 | |
3477 @defvar overlay-arrow-string | |
3478 This variable holds the string to display to call attention to a | |
3479 particular line, or @code{nil} if the arrow feature is not in use. | |
3480 On a graphical display the contents of the string are ignored; instead a | |
3481 glyph is displayed in the fringe area to the left of the display area. | |
3482 @end defvar | |
3483 | |
3484 @defvar overlay-arrow-position | |
3485 This variable holds a marker that indicates where to display the overlay | |
3486 arrow. It should point at the beginning of a line. On a non-graphical | |
3487 display the arrow text | |
3488 appears at the beginning of that line, overlaying any text that would | |
3489 otherwise appear. Since the arrow is usually short, and the line | |
3490 usually begins with indentation, normally nothing significant is | |
3491 overwritten. | |
3492 | |
3493 The overlay-arrow string is displayed in any given buffer if the value | |
3494 of @code{overlay-arrow-position} in that buffer points into that | |
3495 buffer. Thus, it is possible to display multiple overlay arrow strings | |
3496 by creating buffer-local bindings of @code{overlay-arrow-position}. | |
3497 However, it is usually cleaner to use | |
3498 @code{overlay-arrow-variable-list} to achieve this result. | |
3499 @c !!! overlay-arrow-position: but the overlay string may remain in the display | |
3500 @c of some other buffer until an update is required. This should be fixed | |
3501 @c now. Is it? | |
3502 @end defvar | |
3503 | |
3504 You can do a similar job by creating an overlay with a | |
3505 @code{before-string} property. @xref{Overlay Properties}. | |
3506 | |
3507 You can define multiple overlay arrows via the variable | |
3508 @code{overlay-arrow-variable-list}. | |
3509 | |
3510 @defvar overlay-arrow-variable-list | |
3511 This variable's value is a list of variables, each of which specifies | |
3512 the position of an overlay arrow. The variable | |
3513 @code{overlay-arrow-position} has its normal meaning because it is on | |
3514 this list. | |
3515 @end defvar | |
3516 | |
3517 Each variable on this list can have properties | |
3518 @code{overlay-arrow-string} and @code{overlay-arrow-bitmap} that | |
3519 specify an overlay arrow string (for text-only terminals) or fringe | |
3520 bitmap (for graphical terminals) to display at the corresponding | |
3521 overlay arrow position. If either property is not set, the default | |
3522 @code{overlay-arrow-string} or @code{overlay-arrow} fringe indicator | |
3523 is used. | |
3524 | |
3525 @node Scroll Bars | |
3526 @section Scroll Bars | |
3527 @cindex scroll bars | |
3528 | |
3529 Normally the frame parameter @code{vertical-scroll-bars} controls | |
3530 whether the windows in the frame have vertical scroll bars, and | |
3531 whether they are on the left or right. The frame parameter | |
3532 @code{scroll-bar-width} specifies how wide they are (@code{nil} | |
3533 meaning the default). @xref{Layout Parameters}. | |
3534 | |
3535 @defun frame-current-scroll-bars &optional frame | |
3536 This function reports the scroll bar type settings for frame | |
3537 @var{frame}. The value is a cons cell | |
3538 @code{(@var{vertical-type} .@: @var{horizontal-type})}, where | |
3539 @var{vertical-type} is either @code{left}, @code{right}, or @code{nil} | |
3540 (which means no scroll bar.) @var{horizontal-type} is meant to | |
3541 specify the horizontal scroll bar type, but since they are not | |
3542 implemented, it is always @code{nil}. | |
3543 @end defun | |
3544 | |
3545 @vindex vertical-scroll-bar | |
3546 You can enable or disable scroll bars for a particular buffer, | |
3547 by setting the variable @code{vertical-scroll-bar}. This variable | |
3548 automatically becomes buffer-local when set. The possible values are | |
3549 @code{left}, @code{right}, @code{t}, which means to use the | |
3550 frame's default, and @code{nil} for no scroll bar. | |
3551 | |
3552 You can also control this for individual windows. Call the function | |
3553 @code{set-window-scroll-bars} to specify what to do for a specific window: | |
3554 | |
3555 @defun set-window-scroll-bars window width &optional vertical-type horizontal-type | |
3556 This function sets the width and type of scroll bars for window | |
3557 @var{window}. | |
3558 | |
3559 @var{width} specifies the scroll bar width in pixels (@code{nil} means | |
3560 use the width specified for the frame). @var{vertical-type} specifies | |
3561 whether to have a vertical scroll bar and, if so, where. The possible | |
3562 values are @code{left}, @code{right} and @code{nil}, just like the | |
3563 values of the @code{vertical-scroll-bars} frame parameter. | |
3564 | |
3565 The argument @var{horizontal-type} is meant to specify whether and | |
3566 where to have horizontal scroll bars, but since they are not | |
3567 implemented, it has no effect. If @var{window} is @code{nil}, the | |
3568 selected window is used. | |
3569 @end defun | |
3570 | |
3571 @defun window-scroll-bars &optional window | |
3572 Report the width and type of scroll bars specified for @var{window}. | |
3573 If @var{window} is omitted or @code{nil}, the selected window is used. | |
3574 The value is a list of the form @code{(@var{width} | |
3575 @var{cols} @var{vertical-type} @var{horizontal-type})}. The value | |
3576 @var{width} is the value that was specified for the width (which may | |
3577 be @code{nil}); @var{cols} is the number of columns that the scroll | |
3578 bar actually occupies. | |
3579 | |
3580 @var{horizontal-type} is not actually meaningful. | |
3581 @end defun | |
3582 | |
3583 If you don't specify these values for a window with | |
3584 @code{set-window-scroll-bars}, the buffer-local variables | |
3585 @code{scroll-bar-mode} and @code{scroll-bar-width} in the buffer being | |
3586 displayed control the window's vertical scroll bars. The function | |
3587 @code{set-window-buffer} examines these variables. If you change them | |
3588 in a buffer that is already visible in a window, you can make the | |
3589 window take note of the new values by calling @code{set-window-buffer} | |
3590 specifying the same buffer that is already displayed. | |
3591 | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
3592 @defopt scroll-bar-mode |
84060 | 3593 This variable, always local in all buffers, controls whether and where |
3594 to put scroll bars in windows displaying the buffer. The possible values | |
3595 are @code{nil} for no scroll bar, @code{left} to put a scroll bar on | |
3596 the left, and @code{right} to put a scroll bar on the right. | |
103273
c32ec20d0ab5
* abbrevs.texi (Abbrev Mode): abbrev-mode is an option.
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
102981
diff
changeset
|
3597 @end defopt |
84060 | 3598 |
3599 @defun window-current-scroll-bars &optional window | |
3600 This function reports the scroll bar type for window @var{window}. | |
3601 If @var{window} is omitted or @code{nil}, the selected window is used. | |
3602 The value is a cons cell | |
3603 @code{(@var{vertical-type} .@: @var{horizontal-type})}. Unlike | |
3604 @code{window-scroll-bars}, this reports the scroll bar type actually | |
3605 used, once frame defaults and @code{scroll-bar-mode} are taken into | |
3606 account. | |
3607 @end defun | |
3608 | |
3609 @defvar scroll-bar-width | |
3610 This variable, always local in all buffers, specifies the width of the | |
3611 buffer's scroll bars, measured in pixels. A value of @code{nil} means | |
3612 to use the value specified by the frame. | |
3613 @end defvar | |
3614 | |
3615 @node Display Property | |
3616 @section The @code{display} Property | |
3617 @cindex display specification | |
3618 @kindex display @r{(text property)} | |
3619 | |
3620 The @code{display} text property (or overlay property) is used to | |
3621 insert images into text, and also control other aspects of how text | |
3622 displays. The value of the @code{display} property should be a | |
3623 display specification, or a list or vector containing several display | |
85311 | 3624 specifications. Display specifications in the same @code{display} |
3625 property value generally apply in parallel to the text they cover. | |
3626 | |
3627 If several sources (overlays and/or a text property) specify values | |
3628 for the @code{display} property, only one of the values takes effect, | |
3629 following the rules of @code{get-char-property}. @xref{Examining | |
3630 Properties}. | |
3631 | |
3632 The rest of this section describes several kinds of | |
3633 display specifications and what they mean. | |
3634 | |
3635 @menu | |
3636 * Replacing Specs:: Display specs that replace the text. | |
3637 * Specified Space:: Displaying one space with a specified width. | |
3638 * Pixel Specification:: Specifying space width or height in pixels. | |
3639 * Other Display Specs:: Displaying an image; magnifying text; moving it | |
3640 up or down on the page; adjusting the width | |
3641 of spaces within text. | |
3642 * Display Margins:: Displaying text or images to the side of the main text. | |
3643 @end menu | |
3644 | |
3645 @node Replacing Specs | |
3646 @subsection Display Specs That Replace The Text | |
85114 | 3647 |
3648 Some kinds of @code{display} specifications specify something to | |
85311 | 3649 display instead of the text that has the property. These are called |
3650 @dfn{replacing} display specifications. Emacs does not allow the user | |
3651 to interactively move point into the middle of buffer text that is | |
3652 replaced in this way. | |
3653 | |
3654 If a list of display specifications includes more than one replacing | |
3655 display specification, the first overrides the rest. Replacing | |
3656 display specifications make most other display specifications | |
3657 irrelevant, since those don't apply to the replacement. | |
3658 | |
3659 For replacing display specifications, ``the text that has the | |
3660 property'' means all the consecutive characters that have the same | |
3661 Lisp object as their @code{display} property; these characters are | |
3662 replaced as a single unit. By contrast, characters that have similar | |
3663 but distinct Lisp objects as their @code{display} properties are | |
3664 handled separately. Here's a function that illustrates this point: | |
84060 | 3665 |
3666 @smallexample | |
3667 (defun foo () | |
3668 (goto-char (point-min)) | |
3669 (dotimes (i 5) | |
3670 (let ((string (concat "A"))) | |
3671 (put-text-property (point) (1+ (point)) 'display string) | |
3672 (forward-char 1) | |
3673 (put-text-property (point) (1+ (point)) 'display string) | |
3674 (forward-char 1)))) | |
3675 @end smallexample | |
3676 | |
3677 @noindent | |
3678 It gives each of the first ten characters in the buffer string | |
3679 @code{"A"} as the @code{display} property, but they don't all get the | |
3680 same string. The first two characters get the same string, so they | |
3681 together are replaced with one @samp{A}. The next two characters get | |
3682 a second string, so they together are replaced with one @samp{A}. | |
3683 Likewise for each following pair of characters. Thus, the ten | |
3684 characters appear as five A's. This function would have the same | |
3685 results: | |
3686 | |
3687 @smallexample | |
3688 (defun foo () | |
3689 (goto-char (point-min)) | |
3690 (dotimes (i 5) | |
3691 (let ((string (concat "A"))) | |
85114 | 3692 (put-text-property (point) (+ 2 (point)) 'display string) |
84060 | 3693 (put-text-property (point) (1+ (point)) 'display string) |
3694 (forward-char 2)))) | |
3695 @end smallexample | |
3696 | |
3697 @noindent | |
3698 This illustrates that what matters is the property value for | |
3699 each character. If two consecutive characters have the same | |
3700 object as the @code{display} property value, it's irrelevant | |
3701 whether they got this property from a single call to | |
3702 @code{put-text-property} or from two different calls. | |
3703 | |
3704 @node Specified Space | |
3705 @subsection Specified Spaces | |
3706 @cindex spaces, specified height or width | |
3707 @cindex variable-width spaces | |
3708 | |
3709 To display a space of specified width and/or height, use a display | |
3710 specification of the form @code{(space . @var{props})}, where | |
3711 @var{props} is a property list (a list of alternating properties and | |
3712 values). You can put this property on one or more consecutive | |
3713 characters; a space of the specified height and width is displayed in | |
3714 place of @emph{all} of those characters. These are the properties you | |
3715 can use in @var{props} to specify the weight of the space: | |
3716 | |
3717 @table @code | |
3718 @item :width @var{width} | |
3719 If @var{width} is an integer or floating point number, it specifies | |
3720 that the space width should be @var{width} times the normal character | |
3721 width. @var{width} can also be a @dfn{pixel width} specification | |
3722 (@pxref{Pixel Specification}). | |
3723 | |
3724 @item :relative-width @var{factor} | |
3725 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the | |
3726 first character in the group of consecutive characters that have the | |
3727 same @code{display} property. The space width is the width of that | |
3728 character, multiplied by @var{factor}. | |
3729 | |
3730 @item :align-to @var{hpos} | |
3731 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach @var{hpos}. | |
3732 If @var{hpos} is a number, it is measured in units of the normal | |
3733 character width. @var{hpos} can also be a @dfn{pixel width} | |
3734 specification (@pxref{Pixel Specification}). | |
3735 @end table | |
3736 | |
3737 You should use one and only one of the above properties. You can | |
3738 also specify the height of the space, with these properties: | |
3739 | |
3740 @table @code | |
3741 @item :height @var{height} | |
3742 Specifies the height of the space. | |
3743 If @var{height} is an integer or floating point number, it specifies | |
3744 that the space height should be @var{height} times the normal character | |
3745 height. The @var{height} may also be a @dfn{pixel height} specification | |
3746 (@pxref{Pixel Specification}). | |
3747 | |
3748 @item :relative-height @var{factor} | |
3749 Specifies the height of the space, multiplying the ordinary height | |
3750 of the text having this display specification by @var{factor}. | |
3751 | |
3752 @item :ascent @var{ascent} | |
3753 If the value of @var{ascent} is a non-negative number no greater than | |
3754 100, it specifies that @var{ascent} percent of the height of the space | |
3755 should be considered as the ascent of the space---that is, the part | |
3756 above the baseline. The ascent may also be specified in pixel units | |
3757 with a @dfn{pixel ascent} specification (@pxref{Pixel Specification}). | |
3758 | |
3759 @end table | |
3760 | |
3761 Don't use both @code{:height} and @code{:relative-height} together. | |
3762 | |
3763 The @code{:width} and @code{:align-to} properties are supported on | |
3764 non-graphic terminals, but the other space properties in this section | |
3765 are not. | |
3766 | |
3767 @node Pixel Specification | |
3768 @subsection Pixel Specification for Spaces | |
3769 @cindex spaces, pixel specification | |
3770 | |
3771 The value of the @code{:width}, @code{:align-to}, @code{:height}, | |
3772 and @code{:ascent} properties can be a special kind of expression that | |
3773 is evaluated during redisplay. The result of the evaluation is used | |
3774 as an absolute number of pixels. | |
3775 | |
3776 The following expressions are supported: | |
3777 | |
3778 @smallexample | |
3779 @group | |
3780 @var{expr} ::= @var{num} | (@var{num}) | @var{unit} | @var{elem} | @var{pos} | @var{image} | @var{form} | |
3781 @var{num} ::= @var{integer} | @var{float} | @var{symbol} | |
3782 @var{unit} ::= in | mm | cm | width | height | |
3783 @end group | |
3784 @group | |
3785 @var{elem} ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin | |
3786 | scroll-bar | text | |
3787 @var{pos} ::= left | center | right | |
3788 @var{form} ::= (@var{num} . @var{expr}) | (@var{op} @var{expr} ...) | |
3789 @var{op} ::= + | - | |
3790 @end group | |
3791 @end smallexample | |
3792 | |
3793 The form @var{num} specifies a fraction of the default frame font | |
3794 height or width. The form @code{(@var{num})} specifies an absolute | |
3795 number of pixels. If @var{num} is a symbol, @var{symbol}, its | |
3796 buffer-local variable binding is used. | |
3797 | |
3798 The @code{in}, @code{mm}, and @code{cm} units specify the number of | |
3799 pixels per inch, millimeter, and centimeter, respectively. The | |
3800 @code{width} and @code{height} units correspond to the default width | |
3801 and height of the current face. An image specification @code{image} | |
3802 corresponds to the width or height of the image. | |
3803 | |
3804 The @code{left-fringe}, @code{right-fringe}, @code{left-margin}, | |
3805 @code{right-margin}, @code{scroll-bar}, and @code{text} elements | |
3806 specify to the width of the corresponding area of the window. | |
3807 | |
3808 The @code{left}, @code{center}, and @code{right} positions can be | |
3809 used with @code{:align-to} to specify a position relative to the left | |
3810 edge, center, or right edge of the text area. | |
3811 | |
3812 Any of the above window elements (except @code{text}) can also be | |
3813 used with @code{:align-to} to specify that the position is relative to | |
3814 the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for a relative | |
3815 position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of these | |
3816 symbols), further occurrences of these symbols are interpreted as the | |
3817 width of the specified area. For example, to align to the center of | |
3818 the left-margin, use | |
3819 | |
3820 @example | |
3821 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin)) | |
3822 @end example | |
3823 | |
3824 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative | |
3825 to the left edge of the text area. For example, @samp{:align-to 0} in a | |
3826 header-line aligns with the first text column in the text area. | |
3827 | |
3828 A value of the form @code{(@var{num} . @var{expr})} stands for the | |
3829 product of the values of @var{num} and @var{expr}. For example, | |
3830 @code{(2 . in)} specifies a width of 2 inches, while @code{(0.5 . | |
3831 @var{image})} specifies half the width (or height) of the specified | |
3832 image. | |
3833 | |
3834 The form @code{(+ @var{expr} ...)} adds up the value of the | |
3835 expressions. The form @code{(- @var{expr} ...)} negates or subtracts | |
3836 the value of the expressions. | |
3837 | |
3838 @node Other Display Specs | |
3839 @subsection Other Display Specifications | |
3840 | |
3841 Here are the other sorts of display specifications that you can use | |
3842 in the @code{display} text property. | |
3843 | |
3844 @table @code | |
3845 @item @var{string} | |
3846 Display @var{string} instead of the text that has this property. | |
3847 | |
3848 Recursive display specifications are not supported---@var{string}'s | |
3849 @code{display} properties, if any, are not used. | |
3850 | |
3851 @item (image . @var{image-props}) | |
3852 This kind of display specification is an image descriptor (@pxref{Images}). | |
3853 When used as a display specification, it means to display the image | |
3854 instead of the text that has the display specification. | |
3855 | |
3856 @item (slice @var{x} @var{y} @var{width} @var{height}) | |
3857 This specification together with @code{image} specifies a @dfn{slice} | |
3858 (a partial area) of the image to display. The elements @var{y} and | |
3859 @var{x} specify the top left corner of the slice, within the image; | |
3860 @var{width} and @var{height} specify the width and height of the | |
3861 slice. Integer values are numbers of pixels. A floating point number | |
3862 in the range 0.0--1.0 stands for that fraction of the width or height | |
3863 of the entire image. | |
3864 | |
3865 @item ((margin nil) @var{string}) | |
3866 A display specification of this form means to display @var{string} | |
3867 instead of the text that has the display specification, at the same | |
3868 position as that text. It is equivalent to using just @var{string}, | |
3869 but it is done as a special case of marginal display (@pxref{Display | |
3870 Margins}). | |
3871 | |
3872 @item (space-width @var{factor}) | |
3873 This display specification affects all the space characters within the | |
3874 text that has the specification. It displays all of these spaces | |
3875 @var{factor} times as wide as normal. The element @var{factor} should | |
3876 be an integer or float. Characters other than spaces are not affected | |
3877 at all; in particular, this has no effect on tab characters. | |
3878 | |
3879 @item (height @var{height}) | |
3880 This display specification makes the text taller or shorter. | |
3881 Here are the possibilities for @var{height}: | |
3882 | |
3883 @table @asis | |
3884 @item @code{(+ @var{n})} | |
3885 This means to use a font that is @var{n} steps larger. A ``step'' is | |
3886 defined by the set of available fonts---specifically, those that match | |
3887 what was otherwise specified for this text, in all attributes except | |
3888 height. Each size for which a suitable font is available counts as | |
3889 another step. @var{n} should be an integer. | |
3890 | |
3891 @item @code{(- @var{n})} | |
3892 This means to use a font that is @var{n} steps smaller. | |
3893 | |
3894 @item a number, @var{factor} | |
3895 A number, @var{factor}, means to use a font that is @var{factor} times | |
3896 as tall as the default font. | |
3897 | |
3898 @item a symbol, @var{function} | |
3899 A symbol is a function to compute the height. It is called with the | |
3900 current height as argument, and should return the new height to use. | |
3901 | |
3902 @item anything else, @var{form} | |
3903 If the @var{height} value doesn't fit the previous possibilities, it is | |
3904 a form. Emacs evaluates it to get the new height, with the symbol | |
3905 @code{height} bound to the current specified font height. | |
3906 @end table | |
3907 | |
3908 @item (raise @var{factor}) | |
3909 This kind of display specification raises or lowers the text | |
3910 it applies to, relative to the baseline of the line. | |
3911 | |
3912 @var{factor} must be a number, which is interpreted as a multiple of the | |
3913 height of the affected text. If it is positive, that means to display | |
3914 the characters raised. If it is negative, that means to display them | |
3915 lower down. | |
3916 | |
3917 If the text also has a @code{height} display specification, that does | |
3918 not affect the amount of raising or lowering, which is based on the | |
3919 faces used for the text. | |
3920 @end table | |
3921 | |
3922 @c We put all the `@code{(when ...)}' on one line to encourage | |
3923 @c makeinfo's end-of-sentence heuristics to DTRT. Previously, the dot | |
3924 @c was at eol; the info file ended up w/ two spaces rendered after it. | |
3925 You can make any display specification conditional. To do that, | |
3926 package it in another list of the form | |
3927 @code{(when @var{condition} . @var{spec})}. | |
3928 Then the specification @var{spec} applies only when | |
3929 @var{condition} evaluates to a non-@code{nil} value. During the | |
3930 evaluation, @code{object} is bound to the string or buffer having the | |
3931 conditional @code{display} property. @code{position} and | |
3932 @code{buffer-position} are bound to the position within @code{object} | |
3933 and the buffer position where the @code{display} property was found, | |
3934 respectively. Both positions can be different when @code{object} is a | |
3935 string. | |
3936 | |
3937 @node Display Margins | |
3938 @subsection Displaying in the Margins | |
3939 @cindex display margins | |
3940 @cindex margins, display | |
3941 | |
85311 | 3942 A buffer can have blank areas called @dfn{display margins} on the |
3943 left and on the right. Ordinary text never appears in these areas, | |
3944 but you can put things into the display margins using the | |
3945 @code{display} property. There is currently no way to make text or | |
3946 images in the margin mouse-sensitive. | |
3947 | |
3948 The way to display something in the margins is to specify it in a | |
3949 margin display specification in the @code{display} property of some | |
3950 text. This is a replacing display specification, meaning that the | |
3951 text you put it on does not get displayed; the margin display appears, | |
3952 but that text does not. | |
3953 | |
3954 A margin display specification looks like @code{((margin | |
102409
1559b2b91761
John Foerch <jjfoerch at earthlink.net> (tiny change)
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
101443
diff
changeset
|
3955 right-margin) @var{spec})} or @code{((margin left-margin) @var{spec})}. |
85311 | 3956 Here, @var{spec} is another display specification that says what to |
3957 display in the margin. Typically it is a string of text to display, | |
3958 or an image descriptor. | |
3959 | |
3960 To display something in the margin @emph{in association with} | |
3961 certain buffer text, without altering or preventing the display of | |
3962 that text, put a @code{before-string} property on the text and put the | |
3963 margin display specification on the contents of the before-string. | |
84060 | 3964 |
3965 Before the display margins can display anything, you must give | |
3966 them a nonzero width. The usual way to do that is to set these | |
3967 variables: | |
3968 | |
3969 @defvar left-margin-width | |
3970 This variable specifies the width of the left margin. | |
3971 It is buffer-local in all buffers. | |
3972 @end defvar | |
3973 | |
3974 @defvar right-margin-width | |
3975 This variable specifies the width of the right margin. | |
3976 It is buffer-local in all buffers. | |
3977 @end defvar | |
3978 | |
3979 Setting these variables does not immediately affect the window. These | |
3980 variables are checked when a new buffer is displayed in the window. | |
3981 Thus, you can make changes take effect by calling | |
3982 @code{set-window-buffer}. | |
3983 | |
3984 You can also set the margin widths immediately. | |
3985 | |
3986 @defun set-window-margins window left &optional right | |
3987 This function specifies the margin widths for window @var{window}. | |
3988 The argument @var{left} controls the left margin and | |
3989 @var{right} controls the right margin (default @code{0}). | |
3990 @end defun | |
3991 | |
3992 @defun window-margins &optional window | |
3993 This function returns the left and right margins of @var{window} | |
3994 as a cons cell of the form @code{(@var{left} . @var{right})}. | |
3995 If @var{window} is @code{nil}, the selected window is used. | |
3996 @end defun | |
3997 | |
3998 @node Images | |
3999 @section Images | |
4000 @cindex images in buffers | |
4001 | |
4002 To display an image in an Emacs buffer, you must first create an image | |
4003 descriptor, then use it as a display specifier in the @code{display} | |
4004 property of text that is displayed (@pxref{Display Property}). | |
4005 | |
4006 Emacs is usually able to display images when it is run on a | |
4007 graphical terminal. Images cannot be displayed in a text terminal, on | |
4008 certain graphical terminals that lack the support for this, or if | |
4009 Emacs is compiled without image support. You can use the function | |
4010 @code{display-images-p} to determine if images can in principle be | |
4011 displayed (@pxref{Display Feature Testing}). | |
4012 | |
4013 @menu | |
4014 * Image Formats:: Supported image formats. | |
4015 * Image Descriptors:: How to specify an image for use in @code{:display}. | |
4016 * XBM Images:: Special features for XBM format. | |
4017 * XPM Images:: Special features for XPM format. | |
4018 * GIF Images:: Special features for GIF format. | |
97725
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4019 * TIFF Images:: Special features for TIFF format. |
101069 | 4020 * PostScript Images:: Special features for PostScript format. |
84060 | 4021 * Other Image Types:: Various other formats are supported. |
4022 * Defining Images:: Convenient ways to define an image for later use. | |
4023 * Showing Images:: Convenient ways to display an image once it is defined. | |
4024 * Image Cache:: Internal mechanisms of image display. | |
4025 @end menu | |
4026 | |
4027 @node Image Formats | |
4028 @subsection Image Formats | |
4029 @cindex image formats | |
4030 @cindex image types | |
4031 | |
4032 Emacs can display a number of different image formats; some of them | |
4033 are supported only if particular support libraries are installed on | |
4034 your machine. In some environments, Emacs can load image | |
4035 libraries on demand; if so, the variable @code{image-library-alist} | |
4036 can be used to modify the set of known names for these dynamic | |
4037 libraries (though it is not possible to add new image formats). | |
4038 | |
4039 The supported image formats include XBM, XPM (this requires the | |
4040 libraries @code{libXpm} version 3.4k and @code{libz}), GIF (requiring | |
4041 @code{libungif} 4.1.0), PostScript, PBM, JPEG (requiring the | |
4042 @code{libjpeg} library version v6a), TIFF (requiring @code{libtiff} | |
4043 v3.4), PNG (requiring @code{libpng} 1.0.2), and SVG (requiring | |
4044 @code{librsvg} 2.0.0). | |
4045 | |
4046 You specify one of these formats with an image type symbol. The image | |
4047 type symbols are @code{xbm}, @code{xpm}, @code{gif}, @code{postscript}, | |
4048 @code{pbm}, @code{jpeg}, @code{tiff}, @code{png}, and @code{svg}. | |
4049 | |
4050 @defvar image-types | |
4051 This variable contains a list of those image type symbols that are | |
4052 potentially supported in the current configuration. | |
4053 @emph{Potentially} here means that Emacs knows about the image types, | |
4054 not necessarily that they can be loaded (they could depend on | |
4055 unavailable dynamic libraries, for example). | |
4056 | |
4057 To know which image types are really available, use | |
4058 @code{image-type-available-p}. | |
4059 @end defvar | |
4060 | |
4061 @defvar image-library-alist | |
4062 This in an alist of image types vs external libraries needed to | |
4063 display them. | |
4064 | |
4065 Each element is a list @code{(@var{image-type} @var{library}...)}, | |
4066 where the car is a supported image format from @code{image-types}, and | |
4067 the rest are strings giving alternate filenames for the corresponding | |
4068 external libraries to load. | |
4069 | |
4070 Emacs tries to load the libraries in the order they appear on the | |
4071 list; if none is loaded, the running session of Emacs won't support | |
4072 the image type. @code{pbm} and @code{xbm} don't need to be listed; | |
4073 they're always supported. | |
4074 | |
4075 This variable is ignored if the image libraries are statically linked | |
4076 into Emacs. | |
4077 @end defvar | |
4078 | |
4079 @defun image-type-available-p type | |
4080 This function returns non-@code{nil} if image type @var{type} is | |
4081 available, i.e., if images of this type can be loaded and displayed in | |
4082 Emacs. @var{type} should be one of the types contained in | |
4083 @code{image-types}. | |
4084 | |
4085 For image types whose support libraries are statically linked, this | |
4086 function always returns @code{t}; for other image types, it returns | |
4087 @code{t} if the dynamic library could be loaded, @code{nil} otherwise. | |
4088 @end defun | |
4089 | |
4090 @node Image Descriptors | |
4091 @subsection Image Descriptors | |
4092 @cindex image descriptor | |
4093 | |
4094 An image description is a list of the form @code{(image . @var{props})}, | |
4095 where @var{props} is a property list containing alternating keyword | |
4096 symbols (symbols whose names start with a colon) and their values. | |
4097 You can use any Lisp object as a property, but the only properties | |
4098 that have any special meaning are certain symbols, all of them keywords. | |
4099 | |
4100 Every image descriptor must contain the property @code{:type | |
4101 @var{type}} to specify the format of the image. The value of @var{type} | |
4102 should be an image type symbol; for example, @code{xpm} for an image in | |
4103 XPM format. | |
4104 | |
4105 Here is a list of other properties that are meaningful for all image | |
4106 types: | |
4107 | |
4108 @table @code | |
4109 @item :file @var{file} | |
4110 The @code{:file} property says to load the image from file | |
4111 @var{file}. If @var{file} is not an absolute file name, it is expanded | |
4112 in @code{data-directory}. | |
4113 | |
4114 @item :data @var{data} | |
4115 The @code{:data} property says the actual contents of the image. | |
4116 Each image must use either @code{:data} or @code{:file}, but not both. | |
4117 For most image types, the value of the @code{:data} property should be a | |
4118 string containing the image data; we recommend using a unibyte string. | |
4119 | |
4120 Before using @code{:data}, look for further information in the section | |
4121 below describing the specific image format. For some image types, | |
4122 @code{:data} may not be supported; for some, it allows other data types; | |
4123 for some, @code{:data} alone is not enough, so you need to use other | |
4124 image properties along with @code{:data}. | |
4125 | |
4126 @item :margin @var{margin} | |
4127 The @code{:margin} property specifies how many pixels to add as an | |
4128 extra margin around the image. The value, @var{margin}, must be a | |
4129 non-negative number, or a pair @code{(@var{x} . @var{y})} of such | |
4130 numbers. If it is a pair, @var{x} specifies how many pixels to add | |
4131 horizontally, and @var{y} specifies how many pixels to add vertically. | |
4132 If @code{:margin} is not specified, the default is zero. | |
4133 | |
4134 @item :ascent @var{ascent} | |
4135 The @code{:ascent} property specifies the amount of the image's | |
4136 height to use for its ascent---that is, the part above the baseline. | |
4137 The value, @var{ascent}, must be a number in the range 0 to 100, or | |
4138 the symbol @code{center}. | |
4139 | |
4140 If @var{ascent} is a number, that percentage of the image's height is | |
4141 used for its ascent. | |
4142 | |
4143 If @var{ascent} is @code{center}, the image is vertically centered | |
4144 around a centerline which would be the vertical centerline of text drawn | |
4145 at the position of the image, in the manner specified by the text | |
4146 properties and overlays that apply to the image. | |
4147 | |
4148 If this property is omitted, it defaults to 50. | |
4149 | |
4150 @item :relief @var{relief} | |
4151 The @code{:relief} property, if non-@code{nil}, adds a shadow rectangle | |
4152 around the image. The value, @var{relief}, specifies the width of the | |
4153 shadow lines, in pixels. If @var{relief} is negative, shadows are drawn | |
4154 so that the image appears as a pressed button; otherwise, it appears as | |
4155 an unpressed button. | |
4156 | |
4157 @item :conversion @var{algorithm} | |
4158 The @code{:conversion} property, if non-@code{nil}, specifies a | |
4159 conversion algorithm that should be applied to the image before it is | |
4160 displayed; the value, @var{algorithm}, specifies which algorithm. | |
4161 | |
4162 @table @code | |
4163 @item laplace | |
4164 @itemx emboss | |
4165 Specifies the Laplace edge detection algorithm, which blurs out small | |
4166 differences in color while highlighting larger differences. People | |
4167 sometimes consider this useful for displaying the image for a | |
4168 ``disabled'' button. | |
4169 | |
4170 @item (edge-detection :matrix @var{matrix} :color-adjust @var{adjust}) | |
4171 Specifies a general edge-detection algorithm. @var{matrix} must be | |
4172 either a nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel | |
4173 at position @math{x/y} in the transformed image is computed from | |
4174 original pixels around that position. @var{matrix} specifies, for each | |
4175 pixel in the neighborhood of @math{x/y}, a factor with which that pixel | |
4176 will influence the transformed pixel; element @math{0} specifies the | |
4177 factor for the pixel at @math{x-1/y-1}, element @math{1} the factor for | |
4178 the pixel at @math{x/y-1} etc., as shown below: | |
4179 @iftex | |
4180 @tex | |
4181 $$\pmatrix{x-1/y-1 & x/y-1 & x+1/y-1 \cr | |
4182 x-1/y & x/y & x+1/y \cr | |
4183 x-1/y+1& x/y+1 & x+1/y+1 \cr}$$ | |
4184 @end tex | |
4185 @end iftex | |
4186 @ifnottex | |
4187 @display | |
4188 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1 | |
4189 x-1/y x/y x+1/y | |
4190 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1) | |
4191 @end display | |
4192 @end ifnottex | |
4193 | |
4194 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color | |
4195 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels, | |
4196 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum | |
4197 of the factors' absolute values. | |
4198 | |
4199 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of | |
4200 @iftex | |
4201 @tex | |
4202 $$\pmatrix{1 & 0 & 0 \cr | |
4203 0& 0 & 0 \cr | |
4204 9 & 9 & -1 \cr}$$ | |
4205 @end tex | |
4206 @end iftex | |
4207 @ifnottex | |
4208 @display | |
4209 (1 0 0 | |
4210 0 0 0 | |
4211 9 9 -1) | |
4212 @end display | |
4213 @end ifnottex | |
4214 | |
4215 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of | |
4216 @iftex | |
4217 @tex | |
4218 $$\pmatrix{ 2 & -1 & 0 \cr | |
4219 -1 & 0 & 1 \cr | |
4220 0 & 1 & -2 \cr}$$ | |
4221 @end tex | |
4222 @end iftex | |
4223 @ifnottex | |
4224 @display | |
4225 ( 2 -1 0 | |
4226 -1 0 1 | |
4227 0 1 -2) | |
4228 @end display | |
4229 @end ifnottex | |
4230 | |
4231 @item disabled | |
4232 Specifies transforming the image so that it looks ``disabled.'' | |
4233 @end table | |
4234 | |
4235 @item :mask @var{mask} | |
4236 If @var{mask} is @code{heuristic} or @code{(heuristic @var{bg})}, build | |
4237 a clipping mask for the image, so that the background of a frame is | |
4238 visible behind the image. If @var{bg} is not specified, or if @var{bg} | |
4239 is @code{t}, determine the background color of the image by looking at | |
4240 the four corners of the image, assuming the most frequently occurring | |
4241 color from the corners is the background color of the image. Otherwise, | |
4242 @var{bg} must be a list @code{(@var{red} @var{green} @var{blue})} | |
4243 specifying the color to assume for the background of the image. | |
4244 | |
4245 If @var{mask} is @code{nil}, remove a mask from the image, if it has | |
4246 one. Images in some formats include a mask which can be removed by | |
4247 specifying @code{:mask nil}. | |
4248 | |
4249 @item :pointer @var{shape} | |
4250 This specifies the pointer shape when the mouse pointer is over this | |
4251 image. @xref{Pointer Shape}, for available pointer shapes. | |
4252 | |
4253 @item :map @var{map} | |
4254 This associates an image map of @dfn{hot spots} with this image. | |
4255 | |
4256 An image map is an alist where each element has the format | |
4257 @code{(@var{area} @var{id} @var{plist})}. An @var{area} is specified | |
4258 as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon. | |
4259 | |
4260 A rectangle is a cons | |
4261 @code{(rect . ((@var{x0} . @var{y0}) . (@var{x1} . @var{y1})))} | |
4262 which specifies the pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right | |
4263 corners of the rectangle area. | |
4264 | |
4265 A circle is a cons | |
4266 @code{(circle . ((@var{x0} . @var{y0}) . @var{r}))} | |
4267 which specifies the center and the radius of the circle; @var{r} may | |
4268 be a float or integer. | |
4269 | |
4270 A polygon is a cons | |
4271 @code{(poly . [@var{x0} @var{y0} @var{x1} @var{y1} ...])} | |
4272 where each pair in the vector describes one corner in the polygon. | |
4273 | |
4274 When the mouse pointer lies on a hot-spot area of an image, the | |
4275 @var{plist} of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a @code{help-echo} | |
4276 property, that defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains | |
4277 a @code{pointer} property, that defines the shape of the mouse cursor when | |
4278 it is on the hot-spot. | |
4279 @xref{Pointer Shape}, for available pointer shapes. | |
4280 | |
4281 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot, an | |
4282 event is composed by combining the @var{id} of the hot-spot with the | |
4283 mouse event; for instance, @code{[area4 mouse-1]} if the hot-spot's | |
4284 @var{id} is @code{area4}. | |
4285 @end table | |
4286 | |
4287 @defun image-mask-p spec &optional frame | |
4288 This function returns @code{t} if image @var{spec} has a mask bitmap. | |
4289 @var{frame} is the frame on which the image will be displayed. | |
4290 @var{frame} @code{nil} or omitted means to use the selected frame | |
4291 (@pxref{Input Focus}). | |
4292 @end defun | |
4293 | |
4294 @node XBM Images | |
4295 @subsection XBM Images | |
4296 @cindex XBM | |
4297 | |
4298 To use XBM format, specify @code{xbm} as the image type. This image | |
4299 format doesn't require an external library, so images of this type are | |
4300 always supported. | |
4301 | |
4302 Additional image properties supported for the @code{xbm} image type are: | |
4303 | |
4304 @table @code | |
4305 @item :foreground @var{foreground} | |
4306 The value, @var{foreground}, should be a string specifying the image | |
4307 foreground color, or @code{nil} for the default color. This color is | |
4308 used for each pixel in the XBM that is 1. The default is the frame's | |
4309 foreground color. | |
4310 | |
4311 @item :background @var{background} | |
4312 The value, @var{background}, should be a string specifying the image | |
4313 background color, or @code{nil} for the default color. This color is | |
4314 used for each pixel in the XBM that is 0. The default is the frame's | |
4315 background color. | |
4316 @end table | |
4317 | |
4318 If you specify an XBM image using data within Emacs instead of an | |
4319 external file, use the following three properties: | |
4320 | |
4321 @table @code | |
4322 @item :data @var{data} | |
4323 The value, @var{data}, specifies the contents of the image. | |
4324 There are three formats you can use for @var{data}: | |
4325 | |
4326 @itemize @bullet | |
4327 @item | |
4328 A vector of strings or bool-vectors, each specifying one line of the | |
4329 image. Do specify @code{:height} and @code{:width}. | |
4330 | |
4331 @item | |
4332 A string containing the same byte sequence as an XBM file would contain. | |
4333 You must not specify @code{:height} and @code{:width} in this case, | |
4334 because omitting them is what indicates the data has the format of an | |
4335 XBM file. The file contents specify the height and width of the image. | |
4336 | |
4337 @item | |
4338 A string or a bool-vector containing the bits of the image (plus perhaps | |
4339 some extra bits at the end that will not be used). It should contain at | |
4340 least @var{width} * @code{height} bits. In this case, you must specify | |
4341 @code{:height} and @code{:width}, both to indicate that the string | |
4342 contains just the bits rather than a whole XBM file, and to specify the | |
4343 size of the image. | |
4344 @end itemize | |
4345 | |
4346 @item :width @var{width} | |
4347 The value, @var{width}, specifies the width of the image, in pixels. | |
4348 | |
4349 @item :height @var{height} | |
4350 The value, @var{height}, specifies the height of the image, in pixels. | |
4351 @end table | |
4352 | |
4353 @node XPM Images | |
4354 @subsection XPM Images | |
4355 @cindex XPM | |
4356 | |
4357 To use XPM format, specify @code{xpm} as the image type. The | |
4358 additional image property @code{:color-symbols} is also meaningful with | |
4359 the @code{xpm} image type: | |
4360 | |
4361 @table @code | |
4362 @item :color-symbols @var{symbols} | |
4363 The value, @var{symbols}, should be an alist whose elements have the | |
4364 form @code{(@var{name} . @var{color})}. In each element, @var{name} is | |
4365 the name of a color as it appears in the image file, and @var{color} | |
4366 specifies the actual color to use for displaying that name. | |
4367 @end table | |
4368 | |
4369 @node GIF Images | |
4370 @subsection GIF Images | |
4371 @cindex GIF | |
4372 | |
4373 For GIF images, specify image type @code{gif}. | |
4374 | |
4375 @table @code | |
4376 @item :index @var{index} | |
4377 You can use @code{:index} to specify one image from a GIF file that | |
4378 contains more than one image. This property specifies use of image | |
4379 number @var{index} from the file. If the GIF file doesn't contain an | |
4380 image with index @var{index}, the image displays as a hollow box. | |
4381 @end table | |
4382 | |
4383 @ignore | |
4384 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs. | |
4385 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file | |
4386 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images | |
4387 every 0.1 seconds. | |
4388 | |
4389 (defun show-anim (file max) | |
4390 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages." | |
4391 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t)) | |
4392 | |
4393 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time) | |
4394 (when (= idx max) | |
4395 (setq idx 0)) | |
4396 (let ((img (create-image file nil :image idx))) | |
106731
79fa2d910b72
Avoid dubious uses of save-excursions.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
105192
diff
changeset
|
4397 (with-current-buffer buffer |
84060 | 4398 (goto-char (point-min)) |
4399 (unless first-time (delete-char 1)) | |
4400 (insert-image img)) | |
4401 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil))) | |
4402 @end ignore | |
4403 | |
97725
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4404 @node TIFF Images |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4405 @subsection TIFF Images |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4406 @cindex TIFF |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4407 |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4408 For TIFF images, specify image type @code{tiff}. |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4409 |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4410 @table @code |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4411 @item :index @var{index} |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4412 You can use @code{:index} to specify one image from a TIFF file that |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4413 contains more than one image. This property specifies use of image |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4414 number @var{index} from the file. If the TIFF file doesn't contain an |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4415 image with index @var{index}, the image displays as a hollow box. |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4416 @end table |
7660589a4e25
(TIFF Images): New section describing :index property.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
97627
diff
changeset
|
4417 |
101069 | 4418 @node PostScript Images |
4419 @subsection PostScript Images | |
4420 @cindex postscript images | |
4421 | |
4422 To use PostScript for an image, specify image type @code{postscript}. | |
4423 This works only if you have Ghostscript installed. You must always use | |
4424 these three properties: | |
4425 | |
4426 @table @code | |
4427 @item :pt-width @var{width} | |
4428 The value, @var{width}, specifies the width of the image measured in | |
4429 points (1/72 inch). @var{width} must be an integer. | |
4430 | |
4431 @item :pt-height @var{height} | |
4432 The value, @var{height}, specifies the height of the image in points | |
4433 (1/72 inch). @var{height} must be an integer. | |
4434 | |
4435 @item :bounding-box @var{box} | |
4436 The value, @var{box}, must be a list or vector of four integers, which | |
4437 specifying the bounding box of the PostScript image, analogous to the | |
4438 @samp{BoundingBox} comment found in PostScript files. | |
4439 | |
4440 @example | |
4441 %%BoundingBox: 22 171 567 738 | |
4442 @end example | |
4443 @end table | |
4444 | |
84060 | 4445 @node Other Image Types |
4446 @subsection Other Image Types | |
4447 @cindex PBM | |
4448 | |
4449 For PBM images, specify image type @code{pbm}. Color, gray-scale and | |
4450 monochromatic images are supported. For mono PBM images, two additional | |
4451 image properties are supported. | |
4452 | |
4453 @table @code | |
4454 @item :foreground @var{foreground} | |
4455 The value, @var{foreground}, should be a string specifying the image | |
4456 foreground color, or @code{nil} for the default color. This color is | |
96396
e29e1bbed939
(Other Image Types): Fix copy/paste error; say "PBM", not "XBM".
Johan Bockgård <bojohan@gnu.org>
parents:
95563
diff
changeset
|
4457 used for each pixel in the PBM that is 1. The default is the frame's |
84060 | 4458 foreground color. |
4459 | |
4460 @item :background @var{background} | |
4461 The value, @var{background}, should be a string specifying the image | |
4462 background color, or @code{nil} for the default color. This color is | |
96396
e29e1bbed939
(Other Image Types): Fix copy/paste error; say "PBM", not "XBM".
Johan Bockgård <bojohan@gnu.org>
parents:
95563
diff
changeset
|
4463 used for each pixel in the PBM that is 0. The default is the frame's |
84060 | 4464 background color. |
4465 @end table | |
4466 | |
4467 For JPEG images, specify image type @code{jpeg}. | |
4468 | |
4469 For TIFF images, specify image type @code{tiff}. | |
4470 | |
4471 For PNG images, specify image type @code{png}. | |
4472 | |
4473 For SVG images, specify image type @code{svg}. | |
4474 | |
4475 @node Defining Images | |
4476 @subsection Defining Images | |
4477 | |
4478 The functions @code{create-image}, @code{defimage} and | |
4479 @code{find-image} provide convenient ways to create image descriptors. | |
4480 | |
4481 @defun create-image file-or-data &optional type data-p &rest props | |
4482 This function creates and returns an image descriptor which uses the | |
4483 data in @var{file-or-data}. @var{file-or-data} can be a file name or | |
4484 a string containing the image data; @var{data-p} should be @code{nil} | |
4485 for the former case, non-@code{nil} for the latter case. | |
4486 | |
4487 The optional argument @var{type} is a symbol specifying the image type. | |
4488 If @var{type} is omitted or @code{nil}, @code{create-image} tries to | |
4489 determine the image type from the file's first few bytes, or else | |
4490 from the file's name. | |
4491 | |
4492 The remaining arguments, @var{props}, specify additional image | |
4493 properties---for example, | |
4494 | |
4495 @example | |
4496 (create-image "foo.xpm" 'xpm nil :heuristic-mask t) | |
4497 @end example | |
4498 | |
4499 The function returns @code{nil} if images of this type are not | |
4500 supported. Otherwise it returns an image descriptor. | |
4501 @end defun | |
4502 | |
4503 @defmac defimage symbol specs &optional doc | |
4504 This macro defines @var{symbol} as an image name. The arguments | |
4505 @var{specs} is a list which specifies how to display the image. | |
4506 The third argument, @var{doc}, is an optional documentation string. | |
4507 | |
4508 Each argument in @var{specs} has the form of a property list, and each | |
4509 one should specify at least the @code{:type} property and either the | |
4510 @code{:file} or the @code{:data} property. The value of @code{:type} | |
4511 should be a symbol specifying the image type, the value of | |
4512 @code{:file} is the file to load the image from, and the value of | |
4513 @code{:data} is a string containing the actual image data. Here is an | |
4514 example: | |
4515 | |
4516 @example | |
4517 (defimage test-image | |
4518 ((:type xpm :file "~/test1.xpm") | |
4519 (:type xbm :file "~/test1.xbm"))) | |
4520 @end example | |
4521 | |
4522 @code{defimage} tests each argument, one by one, to see if it is | |
4523 usable---that is, if the type is supported and the file exists. The | |
4524 first usable argument is used to make an image descriptor which is | |
4525 stored in @var{symbol}. | |
4526 | |
4527 If none of the alternatives will work, then @var{symbol} is defined | |
4528 as @code{nil}. | |
4529 @end defmac | |
4530 | |
4531 @defun find-image specs | |
4532 This function provides a convenient way to find an image satisfying one | |
4533 of a list of image specifications @var{specs}. | |
4534 | |
4535 Each specification in @var{specs} is a property list with contents | |
4536 depending on image type. All specifications must at least contain the | |
4537 properties @code{:type @var{type}} and either @w{@code{:file @var{file}}} | |
4538 or @w{@code{:data @var{DATA}}}, where @var{type} is a symbol specifying | |
4539 the image type, e.g.@: @code{xbm}, @var{file} is the file to load the | |
4540 image from, and @var{data} is a string containing the actual image data. | |
4541 The first specification in the list whose @var{type} is supported, and | |
4542 @var{file} exists, is used to construct the image specification to be | |
4543 returned. If no specification is satisfied, @code{nil} is returned. | |
4544 | |
4545 The image is looked for in @code{image-load-path}. | |
4546 @end defun | |
4547 | |
4548 @defvar image-load-path | |
4549 This variable's value is a list of locations in which to search for | |
4550 image files. If an element is a string or a variable symbol whose | |
4551 value is a string, the string is taken to be the name of a directory | |
4552 to search. If an element is a variable symbol whose value is a list, | |
4553 that is taken to be a list of directory names to search. | |
4554 | |
4555 The default is to search in the @file{images} subdirectory of the | |
4556 directory specified by @code{data-directory}, then the directory | |
4557 specified by @code{data-directory}, and finally in the directories in | |
4558 @code{load-path}. Subdirectories are not automatically included in | |
4559 the search, so if you put an image file in a subdirectory, you have to | |
4560 supply the subdirectory name explicitly. For example, to find the | |
4561 image @file{images/foo/bar.xpm} within @code{data-directory}, you | |
4562 should specify the image as follows: | |
4563 | |
4564 @example | |
4565 (defimage foo-image '((:type xpm :file "foo/bar.xpm"))) | |
4566 @end example | |
4567 @end defvar | |
4568 | |
4569 @defun image-load-path-for-library library image &optional path no-error | |
4570 This function returns a suitable search path for images used by the | |
4571 Lisp package @var{library}. | |
4572 | |
4573 The function searches for @var{image} first using @code{image-load-path}, | |
4574 excluding @file{@code{data-directory}/images}, and then in | |
4575 @code{load-path}, followed by a path suitable for @var{library}, which | |
4576 includes @file{../../etc/images} and @file{../etc/images} relative to | |
4577 the library file itself, and finally in | |
4578 @file{@code{data-directory}/images}. | |
4579 | |
4580 Then this function returns a list of directories which contains first | |
4581 the directory in which @var{image} was found, followed by the value of | |
4582 @code{load-path}. If @var{path} is given, it is used instead of | |
4583 @code{load-path}. | |
4584 | |
4585 If @var{no-error} is non-@code{nil} and a suitable path can't be | |
4586 found, don't signal an error. Instead, return a list of directories as | |
4587 before, except that @code{nil} appears in place of the image directory. | |
4588 | |
4589 Here is an example that uses a common idiom to provide compatibility | |
4590 with versions of Emacs that lack the variable @code{image-load-path}: | |
4591 | |
4592 @example | |
4593 (defvar image-load-path) ; shush compiler | |
4594 (let* ((load-path (image-load-path-for-library | |
4595 "mh-e" "mh-logo.xpm")) | |
4596 (image-load-path (cons (car load-path) | |
4597 (when (boundp 'image-load-path) | |
4598 image-load-path)))) | |
4599 (mh-tool-bar-folder-buttons-init)) | |
4600 @end example | |
4601 @end defun | |
4602 | |
4603 @node Showing Images | |
4604 @subsection Showing Images | |
4605 | |
4606 You can use an image descriptor by setting up the @code{display} | |
4607 property yourself, but it is easier to use the functions in this | |
4608 section. | |
4609 | |
4610 @defun insert-image image &optional string area slice | |
4611 This function inserts @var{image} in the current buffer at point. The | |
4612 value @var{image} should be an image descriptor; it could be a value | |
4613 returned by @code{create-image}, or the value of a symbol defined with | |
4614 @code{defimage}. The argument @var{string} specifies the text to put | |
4615 in the buffer to hold the image. If it is omitted or @code{nil}, | |
4616 @code{insert-image} uses @code{" "} by default. | |
4617 | |
4618 The argument @var{area} specifies whether to put the image in a margin. | |
4619 If it is @code{left-margin}, the image appears in the left margin; | |
4620 @code{right-margin} specifies the right margin. If @var{area} is | |
4621 @code{nil} or omitted, the image is displayed at point within the | |
4622 buffer's text. | |
4623 | |
4624 The argument @var{slice} specifies a slice of the image to insert. If | |
4625 @var{slice} is @code{nil} or omitted the whole image is inserted. | |
4626 Otherwise, @var{slice} is a list @code{(@var{x} @var{y} @var{width} | |
4627 @var{height})} which specifies the @var{x} and @var{y} positions and | |
4628 @var{width} and @var{height} of the image area to insert. Integer | |
4629 values are in units of pixels. A floating point number in the range | |
4630 0.0--1.0 stands for that fraction of the width or height of the entire | |
4631 image. | |
4632 | |
4633 Internally, this function inserts @var{string} in the buffer, and gives | |
4634 it a @code{display} property which specifies @var{image}. @xref{Display | |
4635 Property}. | |
4636 @end defun | |
4637 | |
4638 @defun insert-sliced-image image &optional string area rows cols | |
4639 This function inserts @var{image} in the current buffer at point, like | |
4640 @code{insert-image}, but splits the image into @var{rows}x@var{cols} | |
4641 equally sized slices. | |
4642 @end defun | |
4643 | |
4644 @defun put-image image pos &optional string area | |
4645 This function puts image @var{image} in front of @var{pos} in the | |
4646 current buffer. The argument @var{pos} should be an integer or a | |
4647 marker. It specifies the buffer position where the image should appear. | |
4648 The argument @var{string} specifies the text that should hold the image | |
4649 as an alternative to the default. | |
4650 | |
4651 The argument @var{image} must be an image descriptor, perhaps returned | |
4652 by @code{create-image} or stored by @code{defimage}. | |
4653 | |
4654 The argument @var{area} specifies whether to put the image in a margin. | |
4655 If it is @code{left-margin}, the image appears in the left margin; | |
4656 @code{right-margin} specifies the right margin. If @var{area} is | |
4657 @code{nil} or omitted, the image is displayed at point within the | |
4658 buffer's text. | |
4659 | |
4660 Internally, this function creates an overlay, and gives it a | |
4661 @code{before-string} property containing text that has a @code{display} | |
4662 property whose value is the image. (Whew!) | |
4663 @end defun | |
4664 | |
4665 @defun remove-images start end &optional buffer | |
4666 This function removes images in @var{buffer} between positions | |
4667 @var{start} and @var{end}. If @var{buffer} is omitted or @code{nil}, | |
4668 images are removed from the current buffer. | |
4669 | |
4670 This removes only images that were put into @var{buffer} the way | |
4671 @code{put-image} does it, not images that were inserted with | |
4672 @code{insert-image} or in other ways. | |
4673 @end defun | |
4674 | |
4675 @defun image-size spec &optional pixels frame | |
4676 This function returns the size of an image as a pair | |
4677 @w{@code{(@var{width} . @var{height})}}. @var{spec} is an image | |
4678 specification. @var{pixels} non-@code{nil} means return sizes | |
4679 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical | |
4680 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default | |
4681 font). @var{frame} is the frame on which the image will be displayed. | |
4682 @var{frame} null or omitted means use the selected frame (@pxref{Input | |
4683 Focus}). | |
4684 @end defun | |
4685 | |
4686 @defvar max-image-size | |
4687 This variable is used to define the maximum size of image that Emacs | |
4688 will load. Emacs will refuse to load (and display) any image that is | |
4689 larger than this limit. | |
4690 | |
4691 If the value is an integer, it directly specifies the maximum | |
4692 image height and width, measured in pixels. If it is a floating | |
4693 point number, it specifies the maximum image height and width | |
4694 as a ratio to the frame height and width. If the value is | |
4695 non-numeric, there is no explicit limit on the size of images. | |
4696 | |
4697 The purpose of this variable is to prevent unreasonably large images | |
4698 from accidentally being loaded into Emacs. It only takes effect the | |
4699 first time an image is loaded. Once an image is placed in the image | |
4700 cache, it can always be displayed, even if the value of | |
4701 @var{max-image-size} is subsequently changed (@pxref{Image Cache}). | |
4702 @end defvar | |
4703 | |
4704 @node Image Cache | |
4705 @subsection Image Cache | |
4706 @cindex image cache | |
4707 | |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4708 Emacs caches images so that it can display them again more |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4709 efficiently. When Emacs displays an image, it searches the image |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4710 cache for an existing image specification @code{equal} to the desired |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4711 specification. If a match is found, the image is displayed from the |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4712 cache; otherwise, Emacs loads the image normally. |
84060 | 4713 |
4714 Occasionally, you may need to tell Emacs to refresh the images | |
4715 associated with a given image specification. For example, suppose you | |
4716 display an image using a specification that contains a @code{:file} | |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4717 property. The image is automatically cached, and subsequent displays |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4718 of that image, with the same image specification, will use the image |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4719 cache. If the image file changes in the meantime, Emacs would be |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4720 displaying the old version of the image. In such a situation, you can |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4721 ``refresh'' the image by calling @code{image-refresh}. |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4722 |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4723 In Emacs' current implementation, each graphical terminal possesses |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4724 an image cache, which is shared by all the frames on that terminal |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4725 (@pxref{Multiple Terminals}). Thus, refreshing an image in one frame |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4726 also refreshes it in all other frames on the same terminal. |
84060 | 4727 |
4728 @defun image-refresh spec &optional frame | |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4729 This function refreshes any images with image specifications |
84060 | 4730 @code{equal} to @var{spec} on frame @var{frame}. If @var{frame} is |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4731 @code{nil}, it defaults to the selected frame. If @var{frame} is |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4732 @code{t}, the refresh is applied to all existing frames. |
84060 | 4733 @end defun |
4734 | |
92150
1c088baa9d2d
Allow fine-grained image-cache flushing.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
88019
diff
changeset
|
4735 @defun clear-image-cache &optional filter |
102975
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4736 This function clears an image cache, removing all the images stored in |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4737 it. If @var{filter} is omitted or @code{nil}, it clears the cache for |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4738 the selected frame. If @var{filter} is a frame, it clears the cache |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4739 for that frame. If @var{filter} is @code{t}, all image caches are |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4740 cleared. Otherwise, @var{filter} is taken to be a file name, and all |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4741 images associated with that file name are removed from all image |
efeb215b8665
* display.texi (Truncation): Overlays can use line-prefix and
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102950
diff
changeset
|
4742 caches. |
84060 | 4743 @end defun |
4744 | |
4745 If an image in the image cache has not been displayed for a specified | |
4746 period of time, Emacs removes it from the cache and frees the | |
4747 associated memory. | |
4748 | |
4749 @defvar image-cache-eviction-delay | |
4750 This variable specifies the number of seconds an image can remain in the | |
4751 cache without being displayed. When an image is not displayed for this | |
4752 length of time, Emacs removes it from the image cache. | |
4753 | |
4754 If the value is @code{nil}, Emacs does not remove images from the cache | |
4755 except when you explicitly clear it. This mode can be useful for | |
4756 debugging. | |
4757 @end defvar | |
4758 | |
4759 @node Buttons | |
4760 @section Buttons | |
4761 @cindex buttons in buffers | |
4762 @cindex clickable buttons in buffers | |
4763 | |
4764 The @emph{button} package defines functions for inserting and | |
4765 manipulating clickable (with the mouse, or via keyboard commands) | |
4766 buttons in Emacs buffers, such as might be used for help hyper-links, | |
4767 etc. Emacs uses buttons for the hyper-links in help text and the like. | |
4768 | |
4769 A button is essentially a set of properties attached (via text | |
4770 properties or overlays) to a region of text in an Emacs buffer. These | |
4771 properties are called @dfn{button properties}. | |
4772 | |
4773 One of these properties (@code{action}) is a function, which will | |
4774 be called when the user invokes it using the keyboard or the mouse. | |
4775 The invoked function may then examine the button and use its other | |
4776 properties as desired. | |
4777 | |
4778 In some ways the Emacs button package duplicates functionality offered | |
4779 by the widget package (@pxref{Top, , Introduction, widget, The Emacs | |
4780 Widget Library}), but the button package has the advantage that it is | |
4781 much faster, much smaller, and much simpler to use (for elisp | |
4782 programmers---for users, the result is about the same). The extra | |
4783 speed and space savings are useful mainly if you need to create many | |
4784 buttons in a buffer (for instance an @code{*Apropos*} buffer uses | |
4785 buttons to make entries clickable, and may contain many thousands of | |
4786 entries). | |
4787 | |
4788 @menu | |
4789 * Button Properties:: Button properties with special meanings. | |
4790 * Button Types:: Defining common properties for classes of buttons. | |
4791 * Making Buttons:: Adding buttons to Emacs buffers. | |
4792 * Manipulating Buttons:: Getting and setting properties of buttons. | |
4793 * Button Buffer Commands:: Buffer-wide commands and bindings for buttons. | |
4794 @end menu | |
4795 | |
4796 @node Button Properties | |
4797 @subsection Button Properties | |
4798 @cindex button properties | |
4799 | |
4800 Buttons have an associated list of properties defining their | |
4801 appearance and behavior, and other arbitrary properties may be used | |
4802 for application specific purposes. Some properties that have special | |
4803 meaning to the button package include: | |
4804 | |
4805 @table @code | |
4806 @item action | |
4807 @kindex action @r{(button property)} | |
4808 The function to call when the user invokes the button, which is passed | |
4809 the single argument @var{button}. By default this is @code{ignore}, | |
4810 which does nothing. | |
4811 | |
4812 @item mouse-action | |
4813 @kindex mouse-action @r{(button property)} | |
4814 This is similar to @code{action}, and when present, will be used | |
4815 instead of @code{action} for button invocations resulting from | |
4816 mouse-clicks (instead of the user hitting @key{RET}). If not | |
4817 present, mouse-clicks use @code{action} instead. | |
4818 | |
4819 @item face | |
4820 @kindex face @r{(button property)} | |
4821 This is an Emacs face controlling how buttons of this type are | |
4822 displayed; by default this is the @code{button} face. | |
4823 | |
4824 @item mouse-face | |
4825 @kindex mouse-face @r{(button property)} | |
4826 This is an additional face which controls appearance during | |
4827 mouse-overs (merged with the usual button face); by default this is | |
4828 the usual Emacs @code{highlight} face. | |
4829 | |
4830 @item keymap | |
4831 @kindex keymap @r{(button property)} | |
4832 The button's keymap, defining bindings active within the button | |
4833 region. By default this is the usual button region keymap, stored | |
4834 in the variable @code{button-map}, which defines @key{RET} and | |
4835 @key{mouse-2} to invoke the button. | |
4836 | |
4837 @item type | |
4838 @kindex type @r{(button property)} | |
4839 The button-type of the button. When creating a button, this is | |
4840 usually specified using the @code{:type} keyword argument. | |
4841 @xref{Button Types}. | |
4842 | |
4843 @item help-echo | |
4844 @kindex help-index @r{(button property)} | |
4845 A string displayed by the Emacs tool-tip help system; by default, | |
4846 @code{"mouse-2, RET: Push this button"}. | |
4847 | |
4848 @item follow-link | |
4849 @kindex follow-link @r{(button property)} | |
4850 The follow-link property, defining how a @key{Mouse-1} click behaves | |
102893
97aebffaf765
* text.texi (Yank Commands): Note that yank uses push-mark.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102515
diff
changeset
|
4851 on this button, @xref{Clickable Text}. |
84060 | 4852 |
4853 @item button | |
4854 @kindex button @r{(button property)} | |
4855 All buttons have a non-@code{nil} @code{button} property, which may be useful | |
4856 in finding regions of text that comprise buttons (which is what the | |
4857 standard button functions do). | |
4858 @end table | |
4859 | |
4860 There are other properties defined for the regions of text in a | |
4861 button, but these are not generally interesting for typical uses. | |
4862 | |
4863 @node Button Types | |
4864 @subsection Button Types | |
4865 @cindex button types | |
4866 | |
4867 Every button has a button @emph{type}, which defines default values | |
4868 for the button's properties. Button types are arranged in a | |
4869 hierarchy, with specialized types inheriting from more general types, | |
4870 so that it's easy to define special-purpose types of buttons for | |
4871 specific tasks. | |
4872 | |
4873 @defun define-button-type name &rest properties | |
88019
36cc1038d878
(Button Types): For define-button-type, clarify type of NAME.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
4874 Define a `button type' called @var{name} (a symbol). |
36cc1038d878
(Button Types): For define-button-type, clarify type of NAME.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
4875 The remaining arguments |
84060 | 4876 form a sequence of @var{property value} pairs, specifying default |
4877 property values for buttons with this type (a button's type may be set | |
4878 by giving it a @code{type} property when creating the button, using | |
4879 the @code{:type} keyword argument). | |
4880 | |
4881 In addition, the keyword argument @code{:supertype} may be used to | |
4882 specify a button-type from which @var{name} inherits its default | |
4883 property values. Note that this inheritance happens only when | |
4884 @var{name} is defined; subsequent changes to a supertype are not | |
4885 reflected in its subtypes. | |
4886 @end defun | |
4887 | |
4888 Using @code{define-button-type} to define default properties for | |
4889 buttons is not necessary---buttons without any specified type use the | |
4890 built-in button-type @code{button}---but it is encouraged, since | |
4891 doing so usually makes the resulting code clearer and more efficient. | |
4892 | |
4893 @node Making Buttons | |
4894 @subsection Making Buttons | |
4895 @cindex making buttons | |
4896 | |
4897 Buttons are associated with a region of text, using an overlay or | |
4898 text properties to hold button-specific information, all of which are | |
4899 initialized from the button's type (which defaults to the built-in | |
4900 button type @code{button}). Like all Emacs text, the appearance of | |
4901 the button is governed by the @code{face} property; by default (via | |
4902 the @code{face} property inherited from the @code{button} button-type) | |
4903 this is a simple underline, like a typical web-page link. | |
4904 | |
4905 For convenience, there are two sorts of button-creation functions, | |
4906 those that add button properties to an existing region of a buffer, | |
4907 called @code{make-...button}, and those that also insert the button | |
4908 text, called @code{insert-...button}. | |
4909 | |
4910 The button-creation functions all take the @code{&rest} argument | |
4911 @var{properties}, which should be a sequence of @var{property value} | |
4912 pairs, specifying properties to add to the button; see @ref{Button | |
4913 Properties}. In addition, the keyword argument @code{:type} may be | |
4914 used to specify a button-type from which to inherit other properties; | |
4915 see @ref{Button Types}. Any properties not explicitly specified | |
4916 during creation will be inherited from the button's type (if the type | |
4917 defines such a property). | |
4918 | |
4919 The following functions add a button using an overlay | |
4920 (@pxref{Overlays}) to hold the button properties: | |
4921 | |
4922 @defun make-button beg end &rest properties | |
4923 This makes a button from @var{beg} to @var{end} in the | |
4924 current buffer, and returns it. | |
4925 @end defun | |
4926 | |
4927 @defun insert-button label &rest properties | |
4928 This insert a button with the label @var{label} at point, | |
4929 and returns it. | |
4930 @end defun | |
4931 | |
4932 The following functions are similar, but use Emacs text properties | |
4933 (@pxref{Text Properties}) to hold the button properties, making the | |
4934 button actually part of the text instead of being a property of the | |
4935 buffer. Buttons using text properties do not create markers into the | |
4936 buffer, which is important for speed when you use extremely large | |
4937 numbers of buttons. Both functions return the position of the start | |
4938 of the new button: | |
4939 | |
4940 @defun make-text-button beg end &rest properties | |
4941 This makes a button from @var{beg} to @var{end} in the current buffer, using | |
4942 text properties. | |
4943 @end defun | |
4944 | |
4945 @defun insert-text-button label &rest properties | |
4946 This inserts a button with the label @var{label} at point, using text | |
4947 properties. | |
4948 @end defun | |
4949 | |
4950 @node Manipulating Buttons | |
4951 @subsection Manipulating Buttons | |
4952 @cindex manipulating buttons | |
4953 | |
4954 These are functions for getting and setting properties of buttons. | |
4955 Often these are used by a button's invocation function to determine | |
4956 what to do. | |
4957 | |
4958 Where a @var{button} parameter is specified, it means an object | |
4959 referring to a specific button, either an overlay (for overlay | |
4960 buttons), or a buffer-position or marker (for text property buttons). | |
4961 Such an object is passed as the first argument to a button's | |
4962 invocation function when it is invoked. | |
4963 | |
4964 @defun button-start button | |
4965 Return the position at which @var{button} starts. | |
4966 @end defun | |
4967 | |
4968 @defun button-end button | |
4969 Return the position at which @var{button} ends. | |
4970 @end defun | |
4971 | |
4972 @defun button-get button prop | |
4973 Get the property of button @var{button} named @var{prop}. | |
4974 @end defun | |
4975 | |
4976 @defun button-put button prop val | |
4977 Set @var{button}'s @var{prop} property to @var{val}. | |
4978 @end defun | |
4979 | |
4980 @defun button-activate button &optional use-mouse-action | |
4981 Call @var{button}'s @code{action} property (i.e., invoke it). If | |
4982 @var{use-mouse-action} is non-@code{nil}, try to invoke the button's | |
4983 @code{mouse-action} property instead of @code{action}; if the button | |
4984 has no @code{mouse-action} property, use @code{action} as normal. | |
4985 @end defun | |
4986 | |
4987 @defun button-label button | |
4988 Return @var{button}'s text label. | |
4989 @end defun | |
4990 | |
4991 @defun button-type button | |
4992 Return @var{button}'s button-type. | |
4993 @end defun | |
4994 | |
4995 @defun button-has-type-p button type | |
4996 Return @code{t} if @var{button} has button-type @var{type}, or one of | |
4997 @var{type}'s subtypes. | |
4998 @end defun | |
4999 | |
5000 @defun button-at pos | |
5001 Return the button at position @var{pos} in the current buffer, or @code{nil}. | |
5002 @end defun | |
5003 | |
5004 @defun button-type-put type prop val | |
5005 Set the button-type @var{type}'s @var{prop} property to @var{val}. | |
5006 @end defun | |
5007 | |
5008 @defun button-type-get type prop | |
5009 Get the property of button-type @var{type} named @var{prop}. | |
5010 @end defun | |
5011 | |
5012 @defun button-type-subtype-p type supertype | |
5013 Return @code{t} if button-type @var{type} is a subtype of @var{supertype}. | |
5014 @end defun | |
5015 | |
5016 @node Button Buffer Commands | |
5017 @subsection Button Buffer Commands | |
5018 @cindex button buffer commands | |
5019 | |
5020 These are commands and functions for locating and operating on | |
5021 buttons in an Emacs buffer. | |
5022 | |
5023 @code{push-button} is the command that a user uses to actually `push' | |
5024 a button, and is bound by default in the button itself to @key{RET} | |
5025 and to @key{mouse-2} using a region-specific keymap. Commands | |
5026 that are useful outside the buttons itself, such as | |
5027 @code{forward-button} and @code{backward-button} are additionally | |
5028 available in the keymap stored in @code{button-buffer-map}; a mode | |
5029 which uses buttons may want to use @code{button-buffer-map} as a | |
5030 parent keymap for its keymap. | |
5031 | |
5032 If the button has a non-@code{nil} @code{follow-link} property, and | |
5033 @var{mouse-1-click-follows-link} is set, a quick @key{Mouse-1} click | |
5034 will also activate the @code{push-button} command. | |
102893
97aebffaf765
* text.texi (Yank Commands): Note that yank uses push-mark.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
102515
diff
changeset
|
5035 @xref{Clickable Text}. |
84060 | 5036 |
5037 @deffn Command push-button &optional pos use-mouse-action | |
5038 Perform the action specified by a button at location @var{pos}. | |
5039 @var{pos} may be either a buffer position or a mouse-event. If | |
5040 @var{use-mouse-action} is non-@code{nil}, or @var{pos} is a | |
5041 mouse-event (@pxref{Mouse Events}), try to invoke the button's | |
5042 @code{mouse-action} property instead of @code{action}; if the button | |
5043 has no @code{mouse-action} property, use @code{action} as normal. | |
5044 @var{pos} defaults to point, except when @code{push-button} is invoked | |
5045 interactively as the result of a mouse-event, in which case, the mouse | |
5046 event's position is used. If there's no button at @var{pos}, do | |
5047 nothing and return @code{nil}, otherwise return @code{t}. | |
5048 @end deffn | |
5049 | |
5050 @deffn Command forward-button n &optional wrap display-message | |
5051 Move to the @var{n}th next button, or @var{n}th previous button if | |
5052 @var{n} is negative. If @var{n} is zero, move to the start of any | |
5053 button at point. If @var{wrap} is non-@code{nil}, moving past either | |
5054 end of the buffer continues from the other end. If | |
5055 @var{display-message} is non-@code{nil}, the button's help-echo string | |
5056 is displayed. Any button with a non-@code{nil} @code{skip} property | |
5057 is skipped over. Returns the button found. | |
5058 @end deffn | |
5059 | |
5060 @deffn Command backward-button n &optional wrap display-message | |
5061 Move to the @var{n}th previous button, or @var{n}th next button if | |
5062 @var{n} is negative. If @var{n} is zero, move to the start of any | |
5063 button at point. If @var{wrap} is non-@code{nil}, moving past either | |
5064 end of the buffer continues from the other end. If | |
5065 @var{display-message} is non-@code{nil}, the button's help-echo string | |
5066 is displayed. Any button with a non-@code{nil} @code{skip} property | |
5067 is skipped over. Returns the button found. | |
5068 @end deffn | |
5069 | |
5070 @defun next-button pos &optional count-current | |
5071 @defunx previous-button pos &optional count-current | |
5072 Return the next button after (for @code{next-button} or before (for | |
5073 @code{previous-button}) position @var{pos} in the current buffer. If | |
5074 @var{count-current} is non-@code{nil}, count any button at @var{pos} | |
5075 in the search, instead of starting at the next button. | |
5076 @end defun | |
5077 | |
5078 @node Abstract Display | |
5079 @section Abstract Display | |
5080 @cindex ewoc | |
5081 @cindex display, abstract | |
5082 @cindex display, arbitrary objects | |
5083 @cindex model/view/controller | |
5084 @cindex view part, model/view/controller | |
5085 | |
5086 The Ewoc package constructs buffer text that represents a structure | |
5087 of Lisp objects, and updates the text to follow changes in that | |
5088 structure. This is like the ``view'' component in the | |
5089 ``model/view/controller'' design paradigm. | |
5090 | |
5091 An @dfn{ewoc} is a structure that organizes information required to | |
5092 construct buffer text that represents certain Lisp data. The buffer | |
5093 text of the ewoc has three parts, in order: first, fixed @dfn{header} | |
5094 text; next, textual descriptions of a series of data elements (Lisp | |
5095 objects that you specify); and last, fixed @dfn{footer} text. | |
5096 Specifically, an ewoc contains information on: | |
5097 | |
5098 @itemize @bullet | |
5099 @item | |
5100 The buffer which its text is generated in. | |
5101 | |
5102 @item | |
5103 The text's start position in the buffer. | |
5104 | |
5105 @item | |
5106 The header and footer strings. | |
5107 | |
5108 @item | |
5109 A doubly-linked chain of @dfn{nodes}, each of which contains: | |
5110 | |
5111 @itemize | |
5112 @item | |
5113 A @dfn{data element}, a single Lisp object. | |
5114 | |
5115 @item | |
5116 Links to the preceding and following nodes in the chain. | |
5117 @end itemize | |
5118 | |
5119 @item | |
5120 A @dfn{pretty-printer} function which is responsible for | |
5121 inserting the textual representation of a data | |
5122 element value into the current buffer. | |
5123 @end itemize | |
5124 | |
5125 Typically, you define an ewoc with @code{ewoc-create}, and then pass | |
5126 the resulting ewoc structure to other functions in the Ewoc package to | |
5127 build nodes within it, and display it in the buffer. Once it is | |
5128 displayed in the buffer, other functions determine the correspondance | |
5129 between buffer positions and nodes, move point from one node's textual | |
5130 representation to another, and so forth. @xref{Abstract Display | |
5131 Functions}. | |
5132 | |
5133 A node @dfn{encapsulates} a data element much the way a variable | |
5134 holds a value. Normally, encapsulation occurs as a part of adding a | |
5135 node to the ewoc. You can retrieve the data element value and place a | |
5136 new value in its place, like so: | |
5137 | |
5138 @lisp | |
5139 (ewoc-data @var{node}) | |
5140 @result{} value | |
5141 | |
5142 (ewoc-set-data @var{node} @var{new-value}) | |
5143 @result{} @var{new-value} | |
5144 @end lisp | |
5145 | |
5146 @noindent | |
5147 You can also use, as the data element value, a Lisp object (list or | |
5148 vector) that is a container for the ``real'' value, or an index into | |
5149 some other structure. The example (@pxref{Abstract Display Example}) | |
5150 uses the latter approach. | |
5151 | |
5152 When the data changes, you will want to update the text in the | |
5153 buffer. You can update all nodes by calling @code{ewoc-refresh}, or | |
5154 just specific nodes using @code{ewoc-invalidate}, or all nodes | |
5155 satisfying a predicate using @code{ewoc-map}. Alternatively, you can | |
5156 delete invalid nodes using @code{ewoc-delete} or @code{ewoc-filter}, | |
5157 and add new nodes in their place. Deleting a node from an ewoc deletes | |
5158 its associated textual description from buffer, as well. | |
5159 | |
5160 @menu | |
103820
9e06f7e38c79
(Abstract Display): Merge in some menu descriptions from elisp.texi.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
103586
diff
changeset
|
5161 * Abstract Display Functions:: Functions in the Ewoc package. |
9e06f7e38c79
(Abstract Display): Merge in some menu descriptions from elisp.texi.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
103586
diff
changeset
|
5162 * Abstract Display Example:: Example of using Ewoc. |
84060 | 5163 @end menu |
5164 | |
5165 @node Abstract Display Functions | |
5166 @subsection Abstract Display Functions | |
5167 | |
5168 In this subsection, @var{ewoc} and @var{node} stand for the | |
5169 structures described above (@pxref{Abstract Display}), while | |
5170 @var{data} stands for an arbitrary Lisp object used as a data element. | |
5171 | |
5172 @defun ewoc-create pretty-printer &optional header footer nosep | |
5173 This constructs and returns a new ewoc, with no nodes (and thus no data | |
5174 elements). @var{pretty-printer} should be a function that takes one | |
5175 argument, a data element of the sort you plan to use in this ewoc, and | |
5176 inserts its textual description at point using @code{insert} (and never | |
5177 @code{insert-before-markers}, because that would interfere with the | |
5178 Ewoc package's internal mechanisms). | |
5179 | |
5180 Normally, a newline is automatically inserted after the header, | |
5181 the footer and every node's textual description. If @var{nosep} | |
5182 is non-@code{nil}, no newline is inserted. This may be useful for | |
5183 displaying an entire ewoc on a single line, for example, or for | |
5184 making nodes ``invisible'' by arranging for @var{pretty-printer} | |
5185 to do nothing for those nodes. | |
5186 | |
5187 An ewoc maintains its text in the buffer that is current when | |
5188 you create it, so switch to the intended buffer before calling | |
5189 @code{ewoc-create}. | |
5190 @end defun | |
5191 | |
5192 @defun ewoc-buffer ewoc | |
5193 This returns the buffer where @var{ewoc} maintains its text. | |
5194 @end defun | |
5195 | |
5196 @defun ewoc-get-hf ewoc | |
5197 This returns a cons cell @code{(@var{header} . @var{footer})} | |
5198 made from @var{ewoc}'s header and footer. | |
5199 @end defun | |
5200 | |
5201 @defun ewoc-set-hf ewoc header footer | |
5202 This sets the header and footer of @var{ewoc} to the strings | |
5203 @var{header} and @var{footer}, respectively. | |
5204 @end defun | |
5205 | |
5206 @defun ewoc-enter-first ewoc data | |
5207 @defunx ewoc-enter-last ewoc data | |
5208 These add a new node encapsulating @var{data}, putting it, respectively, | |
5209 at the beginning or end of @var{ewoc}'s chain of nodes. | |
5210 @end defun | |
5211 | |
5212 @defun ewoc-enter-before ewoc node data | |
5213 @defunx ewoc-enter-after ewoc node data | |
5214 These add a new node encapsulating @var{data}, adding it to | |
5215 @var{ewoc} before or after @var{node}, respectively. | |
5216 @end defun | |
5217 | |
5218 @defun ewoc-prev ewoc node | |
5219 @defunx ewoc-next ewoc node | |
5220 These return, respectively, the previous node and the next node of @var{node} | |
5221 in @var{ewoc}. | |
5222 @end defun | |
5223 | |
5224 @defun ewoc-nth ewoc n | |
5225 This returns the node in @var{ewoc} found at zero-based index @var{n}. | |
5226 A negative @var{n} means count from the end. @code{ewoc-nth} returns | |
5227 @code{nil} if @var{n} is out of range. | |
5228 @end defun | |
5229 | |
5230 @defun ewoc-data node | |
5231 This extracts the data encapsulated by @var{node} and returns it. | |
5232 @end defun | |
5233 | |
5234 @defun ewoc-set-data node data | |
5235 This sets the data encapsulated by @var{node} to @var{data}. | |
5236 @end defun | |
5237 | |
5238 @defun ewoc-locate ewoc &optional pos guess | |
5239 This determines the node in @var{ewoc} which contains point (or | |
5240 @var{pos} if specified), and returns that node. If @var{ewoc} has no | |
5241 nodes, it returns @code{nil}. If @var{pos} is before the first node, | |
5242 it returns the first node; if @var{pos} is after the last node, it returns | |
5243 the last node. The optional third arg @var{guess} | |
5244 should be a node that is likely to be near @var{pos}; this doesn't | |
5245 alter the result, but makes the function run faster. | |
5246 @end defun | |
5247 | |
5248 @defun ewoc-location node | |
5249 This returns the start position of @var{node}. | |
5250 @end defun | |
5251 | |
5252 @defun ewoc-goto-prev ewoc arg | |
5253 @defunx ewoc-goto-next ewoc arg | |
5254 These move point to the previous or next, respectively, @var{arg}th node | |
5255 in @var{ewoc}. @code{ewoc-goto-prev} does not move if it is already at | |
5256 the first node or if @var{ewoc} is empty, whereas @code{ewoc-goto-next} | |
5257 moves past the last node, returning @code{nil}. Excepting this special | |
5258 case, these functions return the node moved to. | |
5259 @end defun | |
5260 | |
5261 @defun ewoc-goto-node ewoc node | |
5262 This moves point to the start of @var{node} in @var{ewoc}. | |
5263 @end defun | |
5264 | |
5265 @defun ewoc-refresh ewoc | |
5266 This function regenerates the text of @var{ewoc}. It works by | |
5267 deleting the text between the header and the footer, i.e., all the | |
5268 data elements' representations, and then calling the pretty-printer | |
5269 function for each node, one by one, in order. | |
5270 @end defun | |
5271 | |
5272 @defun ewoc-invalidate ewoc &rest nodes | |
5273 This is similar to @code{ewoc-refresh}, except that only @var{nodes} in | |
5274 @var{ewoc} are updated instead of the entire set. | |
5275 @end defun | |
5276 | |
5277 @defun ewoc-delete ewoc &rest nodes | |
5278 This deletes each node in @var{nodes} from @var{ewoc}. | |
5279 @end defun | |
5280 | |
5281 @defun ewoc-filter ewoc predicate &rest args | |
5282 This calls @var{predicate} for each data element in @var{ewoc} and | |
5283 deletes those nodes for which @var{predicate} returns @code{nil}. | |
5284 Any @var{args} are passed to @var{predicate}. | |
5285 @end defun | |
5286 | |
5287 @defun ewoc-collect ewoc predicate &rest args | |
5288 This calls @var{predicate} for each data element in @var{ewoc} | |
5289 and returns a list of those elements for which @var{predicate} | |
5290 returns non-@code{nil}. The elements in the list are ordered | |
5291 as in the buffer. Any @var{args} are passed to @var{predicate}. | |
5292 @end defun | |
5293 | |
5294 @defun ewoc-map map-function ewoc &rest args | |
5295 This calls @var{map-function} for each data element in @var{ewoc} and | |
5296 updates those nodes for which @var{map-function} returns non-@code{nil}. | |
5297 Any @var{args} are passed to @var{map-function}. | |
5298 @end defun | |
5299 | |
5300 @node Abstract Display Example | |
5301 @subsection Abstract Display Example | |
5302 | |
5303 Here is a simple example using functions of the ewoc package to | |
5304 implement a ``color components display,'' an area in a buffer that | |
5305 represents a vector of three integers (itself representing a 24-bit RGB | |
5306 value) in various ways. | |
5307 | |
5308 @example | |
5309 (setq colorcomp-ewoc nil | |
5310 colorcomp-data nil | |
5311 colorcomp-mode-map nil | |
5312 colorcomp-labels ["Red" "Green" "Blue"]) | |
5313 | |
5314 (defun colorcomp-pp (data) | |
5315 (if data | |
5316 (let ((comp (aref colorcomp-data data))) | |
5317 (insert (aref colorcomp-labels data) "\t: #x" | |
5318 (format "%02X" comp) " " | |
5319 (make-string (ash comp -2) ?#) "\n")) | |
5320 (let ((cstr (format "#%02X%02X%02X" | |
5321 (aref colorcomp-data 0) | |
5322 (aref colorcomp-data 1) | |
5323 (aref colorcomp-data 2))) | |
5324 (samp " (sample text) ")) | |
5325 (insert "Color\t: " | |
5326 (propertize samp 'face `(foreground-color . ,cstr)) | |
5327 (propertize samp 'face `(background-color . ,cstr)) | |
5328 "\n")))) | |
5329 | |
5330 (defun colorcomp (color) | |
5331 "Allow fiddling with COLOR in a new buffer. | |
5332 The buffer is in Color Components mode." | |
5333 (interactive "sColor (name or #RGB or #RRGGBB): ") | |
5334 (when (string= "" color) | |
5335 (setq color "green")) | |
5336 (unless (color-values color) | |
5337 (error "No such color: %S" color)) | |
5338 (switch-to-buffer | |
5339 (generate-new-buffer (format "originally: %s" color))) | |
5340 (kill-all-local-variables) | |
5341 (setq major-mode 'colorcomp-mode | |
5342 mode-name "Color Components") | |
5343 (use-local-map colorcomp-mode-map) | |
5344 (erase-buffer) | |
5345 (buffer-disable-undo) | |
5346 (let ((data (apply 'vector (mapcar (lambda (n) (ash n -8)) | |
5347 (color-values color)))) | |
5348 (ewoc (ewoc-create 'colorcomp-pp | |
5349 "\nColor Components\n\n" | |
5350 (substitute-command-keys | |
5351 "\n\\@{colorcomp-mode-map@}")))) | |
5352 (set (make-local-variable 'colorcomp-data) data) | |
5353 (set (make-local-variable 'colorcomp-ewoc) ewoc) | |
5354 (ewoc-enter-last ewoc 0) | |
5355 (ewoc-enter-last ewoc 1) | |
5356 (ewoc-enter-last ewoc 2) | |
5357 (ewoc-enter-last ewoc nil))) | |
5358 @end example | |
5359 | |
5360 @cindex controller part, model/view/controller | |
5361 This example can be extended to be a ``color selection widget'' (in | |
5362 other words, the controller part of the ``model/view/controller'' | |
5363 design paradigm) by defining commands to modify @code{colorcomp-data} | |
5364 and to ``finish'' the selection process, and a keymap to tie it all | |
5365 together conveniently. | |
5366 | |
5367 @smallexample | |
5368 (defun colorcomp-mod (index limit delta) | |
5369 (let ((cur (aref colorcomp-data index))) | |
5370 (unless (= limit cur) | |
5371 (aset colorcomp-data index (+ cur delta))) | |
5372 (ewoc-invalidate | |
5373 colorcomp-ewoc | |
5374 (ewoc-nth colorcomp-ewoc index) | |
5375 (ewoc-nth colorcomp-ewoc -1)))) | |
5376 | |
5377 (defun colorcomp-R-more () (interactive) (colorcomp-mod 0 255 1)) | |
5378 (defun colorcomp-G-more () (interactive) (colorcomp-mod 1 255 1)) | |
5379 (defun colorcomp-B-more () (interactive) (colorcomp-mod 2 255 1)) | |
5380 (defun colorcomp-R-less () (interactive) (colorcomp-mod 0 0 -1)) | |
5381 (defun colorcomp-G-less () (interactive) (colorcomp-mod 1 0 -1)) | |
5382 (defun colorcomp-B-less () (interactive) (colorcomp-mod 2 0 -1)) | |
5383 | |
5384 (defun colorcomp-copy-as-kill-and-exit () | |
5385 "Copy the color components into the kill ring and kill the buffer. | |
5386 The string is formatted #RRGGBB (hash followed by six hex digits)." | |
5387 (interactive) | |
5388 (kill-new (format "#%02X%02X%02X" | |
5389 (aref colorcomp-data 0) | |
5390 (aref colorcomp-data 1) | |
5391 (aref colorcomp-data 2))) | |
5392 (kill-buffer nil)) | |
5393 | |
5394 (setq colorcomp-mode-map | |
5395 (let ((m (make-sparse-keymap))) | |
5396 (suppress-keymap m) | |
5397 (define-key m "i" 'colorcomp-R-less) | |
5398 (define-key m "o" 'colorcomp-R-more) | |
5399 (define-key m "k" 'colorcomp-G-less) | |
5400 (define-key m "l" 'colorcomp-G-more) | |
5401 (define-key m "," 'colorcomp-B-less) | |
5402 (define-key m "." 'colorcomp-B-more) | |
5403 (define-key m " " 'colorcomp-copy-as-kill-and-exit) | |
5404 m)) | |
5405 @end smallexample | |
5406 | |
5407 Note that we never modify the data in each node, which is fixed when the | |
5408 ewoc is created to be either @code{nil} or an index into the vector | |
5409 @code{colorcomp-data}, the actual color components. | |
5410 | |
5411 @node Blinking | |
5412 @section Blinking Parentheses | |
5413 @cindex parenthesis matching | |
5414 @cindex blinking parentheses | |
5415 @cindex balancing parentheses | |
5416 | |
5417 This section describes the mechanism by which Emacs shows a matching | |
5418 open parenthesis when the user inserts a close parenthesis. | |
5419 | |
5420 @defvar blink-paren-function | |
5421 The value of this variable should be a function (of no arguments) to | |
5422 be called whenever a character with close parenthesis syntax is inserted. | |
5423 The value of @code{blink-paren-function} may be @code{nil}, in which | |
5424 case nothing is done. | |
5425 @end defvar | |
5426 | |
5427 @defopt blink-matching-paren | |
5428 If this variable is @code{nil}, then @code{blink-matching-open} does | |
5429 nothing. | |
5430 @end defopt | |
5431 | |
5432 @defopt blink-matching-paren-distance | |
5433 This variable specifies the maximum distance to scan for a matching | |
5434 parenthesis before giving up. | |
5435 @end defopt | |
5436 | |
5437 @defopt blink-matching-delay | |
5438 This variable specifies the number of seconds for the cursor to remain | |
5439 at the matching parenthesis. A fraction of a second often gives | |
5440 good results, but the default is 1, which works on all systems. | |
5441 @end defopt | |
5442 | |
5443 @deffn Command blink-matching-open | |
5444 This function is the default value of @code{blink-paren-function}. It | |
5445 assumes that point follows a character with close parenthesis syntax and | |
5446 moves the cursor momentarily to the matching opening character. If that | |
5447 character is not already on the screen, it displays the character's | |
5448 context in the echo area. To avoid long delays, this function does not | |
5449 search farther than @code{blink-matching-paren-distance} characters. | |
5450 | |
5451 Here is an example of calling this function explicitly. | |
5452 | |
5453 @smallexample | |
5454 @group | |
5455 (defun interactive-blink-matching-open () | |
5456 @c Do not break this line! -- rms. | |
5457 @c The first line of a doc string | |
5458 @c must stand alone. | |
5459 "Indicate momentarily the start of sexp before point." | |
5460 (interactive) | |
5461 @end group | |
5462 @group | |
5463 (let ((blink-matching-paren-distance | |
5464 (buffer-size)) | |
5465 (blink-matching-paren t)) | |
5466 (blink-matching-open))) | |
5467 @end group | |
5468 @end smallexample | |
5469 @end deffn | |
5470 | |
5471 @node Usual Display | |
5472 @section Usual Display Conventions | |
5473 | |
5474 The usual display conventions define how to display each character | |
5475 code. You can override these conventions by setting up a display table | |
5476 (@pxref{Display Tables}). Here are the usual display conventions: | |
5477 | |
5478 @itemize @bullet | |
5479 @item | |
5480 Character codes 32 through 126 map to glyph codes 32 through 126. | |
5481 Normally this means they display as themselves. | |
5482 | |
5483 @item | |
5484 Character code 9 is a horizontal tab. It displays as whitespace | |
5485 up to a position determined by @code{tab-width}. | |
5486 | |
5487 @item | |
5488 Character code 10 is a newline. | |
5489 | |
5490 @item | |
5491 All other codes in the range 0 through 31, and code 127, display in one | |
5492 of two ways according to the value of @code{ctl-arrow}. If it is | |
5493 non-@code{nil}, these codes map to sequences of two glyphs, where the | |
5494 first glyph is the @acronym{ASCII} code for @samp{^}. (A display table can | |
5495 specify a glyph to use instead of @samp{^}.) Otherwise, these codes map | |
5496 just like the codes in the range 128 to 255. | |
5497 | |
5498 On MS-DOS terminals, Emacs arranges by default for the character code | |
5499 127 to be mapped to the glyph code 127, which normally displays as an | |
5500 empty polygon. This glyph is used to display non-@acronym{ASCII} characters | |
5501 that the MS-DOS terminal doesn't support. @xref{MS-DOS and MULE,,, | |
5502 emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}. | |
5503 | |
5504 @item | |
5505 Character codes 128 through 255 map to sequences of four glyphs, where | |
5506 the first glyph is the @acronym{ASCII} code for @samp{\}, and the others are | |
5507 digit characters representing the character code in octal. (A display | |
5508 table can specify a glyph to use instead of @samp{\}.) | |
5509 | |
5510 @item | |
5511 Multibyte character codes above 256 are displayed as themselves, or as a | |
5512 question mark or empty box if the terminal cannot display that | |
5513 character. | |
5514 @end itemize | |
5515 | |
5516 The usual display conventions apply even when there is a display | |
5517 table, for any character whose entry in the active display table is | |
5518 @code{nil}. Thus, when you set up a display table, you need only | |
5519 specify the characters for which you want special behavior. | |
5520 | |
5521 These display rules apply to carriage return (character code 13), when | |
5522 it appears in the buffer. But that character may not appear in the | |
5523 buffer where you expect it, if it was eliminated as part of end-of-line | |
5524 conversion (@pxref{Coding System Basics}). | |
5525 | |
5526 These variables affect the way certain characters are displayed on the | |
5527 screen. Since they change the number of columns the characters occupy, | |
5528 they also affect the indentation functions. These variables also affect | |
5529 how the mode line is displayed; if you want to force redisplay of the | |
5530 mode line using the new values, call the function | |
5531 @code{force-mode-line-update} (@pxref{Mode Line Format}). | |
5532 | |
5533 @defopt ctl-arrow | |
5534 @cindex control characters in display | |
5535 This buffer-local variable controls how control characters are | |
5536 displayed. If it is non-@code{nil}, they are displayed as a caret | |
5537 followed by the character: @samp{^A}. If it is @code{nil}, they are | |
5538 displayed as a backslash followed by three octal digits: @samp{\001}. | |
5539 @end defopt | |
5540 | |
5541 @defopt tab-width | |
5542 The value of this buffer-local variable is the spacing between tab | |
5543 stops used for displaying tab characters in Emacs buffers. The value | |
5544 is in units of columns, and the default is 8. Note that this feature | |
5545 is completely independent of the user-settable tab stops used by the | |
5546 command @code{tab-to-tab-stop}. @xref{Indent Tabs}. | |
5547 @end defopt | |
5548 | |
5549 @node Display Tables | |
5550 @section Display Tables | |
5551 | |
5552 @cindex display table | |
5553 You can use the @dfn{display table} feature to control how all possible | |
5554 character codes display on the screen. This is useful for displaying | |
5555 European languages that have letters not in the @acronym{ASCII} character | |
5556 set. | |
5557 | |
5558 The display table maps each character code into a sequence of | |
5559 @dfn{glyphs}, each glyph being a graphic that takes up one character | |
5560 position on the screen. You can also define how to display each glyph | |
5561 on your terminal, using the @dfn{glyph table}. | |
5562 | |
5563 Display tables affect how the mode line is displayed; if you want to | |
5564 force redisplay of the mode line using a new display table, call | |
5565 @code{force-mode-line-update} (@pxref{Mode Line Format}). | |
5566 | |
5567 @menu | |
5568 * Display Table Format:: What a display table consists of. | |
5569 * Active Display Table:: How Emacs selects a display table to use. | |
5570 * Glyphs:: How to define a glyph, and what glyphs mean. | |
5571 @end menu | |
5572 | |
5573 @node Display Table Format | |
5574 @subsection Display Table Format | |
5575 | |
5576 A display table is actually a char-table (@pxref{Char-Tables}) with | |
5577 @code{display-table} as its subtype. | |
5578 | |
5579 @defun make-display-table | |
5580 This creates and returns a display table. The table initially has | |
5581 @code{nil} in all elements. | |
5582 @end defun | |
5583 | |
5584 The ordinary elements of the display table are indexed by character | |
5585 codes; the element at index @var{c} says how to display the character | |
5586 code @var{c}. The value should be @code{nil} or a vector of the | |
5587 glyphs to be output (@pxref{Glyphs}). @code{nil} says to display the | |
5588 character @var{c} according to the usual display conventions | |
5589 (@pxref{Usual Display}). | |
5590 | |
5591 @strong{Warning:} if you use the display table to change the display | |
5592 of newline characters, the whole buffer will be displayed as one long | |
5593 ``line.'' | |
5594 | |
5595 The display table also has six ``extra slots'' which serve special | |
5596 purposes. Here is a table of their meanings; @code{nil} in any slot | |
5597 means to use the default for that slot, as stated below. | |
5598 | |
5599 @table @asis | |
5600 @item 0 | |
5601 The glyph for the end of a truncated screen line (the default for this | |
5602 is @samp{$}). @xref{Glyphs}. On graphical terminals, Emacs uses | |
5603 arrows in the fringes to indicate truncation, so the display table has | |
5604 no effect. | |
5605 | |
5606 @item 1 | |
5607 The glyph for the end of a continued line (the default is @samp{\}). | |
5608 On graphical terminals, Emacs uses curved arrows in the fringes to | |
5609 indicate continuation, so the display table has no effect. | |
5610 | |
5611 @item 2 | |
5612 The glyph for indicating a character displayed as an octal character | |
5613 code (the default is @samp{\}). | |
5614 | |
5615 @item 3 | |
5616 The glyph for indicating a control character (the default is @samp{^}). | |
5617 | |
5618 @item 4 | |
5619 A vector of glyphs for indicating the presence of invisible lines (the | |
5620 default is @samp{...}). @xref{Selective Display}. | |
5621 | |
5622 @item 5 | |
5623 The glyph used to draw the border between side-by-side windows (the | |
5624 default is @samp{|}). @xref{Splitting Windows}. This takes effect only | |
5625 when there are no scroll bars; if scroll bars are supported and in use, | |
5626 a scroll bar separates the two windows. | |
5627 @end table | |
5628 | |
5629 For example, here is how to construct a display table that mimics the | |
5630 effect of setting @code{ctl-arrow} to a non-@code{nil} value: | |
5631 | |
5632 @example | |
5633 (setq disptab (make-display-table)) | |
5634 (let ((i 0)) | |
5635 (while (< i 32) | |
5636 (or (= i ?\t) (= i ?\n) | |
5637 (aset disptab i (vector ?^ (+ i 64)))) | |
5638 (setq i (1+ i))) | |
5639 (aset disptab 127 (vector ?^ ??))) | |
5640 @end example | |
5641 | |
5642 @defun display-table-slot display-table slot | |
5643 This function returns the value of the extra slot @var{slot} of | |
5644 @var{display-table}. The argument @var{slot} may be a number from 0 to | |
5645 5 inclusive, or a slot name (symbol). Valid symbols are | |
5646 @code{truncation}, @code{wrap}, @code{escape}, @code{control}, | |
5647 @code{selective-display}, and @code{vertical-border}. | |
5648 @end defun | |
5649 | |
5650 @defun set-display-table-slot display-table slot value | |
5651 This function stores @var{value} in the extra slot @var{slot} of | |
5652 @var{display-table}. The argument @var{slot} may be a number from 0 to | |
5653 5 inclusive, or a slot name (symbol). Valid symbols are | |
5654 @code{truncation}, @code{wrap}, @code{escape}, @code{control}, | |
5655 @code{selective-display}, and @code{vertical-border}. | |
5656 @end defun | |
5657 | |
5658 @defun describe-display-table display-table | |
5659 This function displays a description of the display table | |
5660 @var{display-table} in a help buffer. | |
5661 @end defun | |
5662 | |
5663 @deffn Command describe-current-display-table | |
5664 This command displays a description of the current display table in a | |
5665 help buffer. | |
5666 @end deffn | |
5667 | |
5668 @node Active Display Table | |
5669 @subsection Active Display Table | |
5670 @cindex active display table | |
5671 | |
5672 Each window can specify a display table, and so can each buffer. When | |
5673 a buffer @var{b} is displayed in window @var{w}, display uses the | |
5674 display table for window @var{w} if it has one; otherwise, the display | |
5675 table for buffer @var{b} if it has one; otherwise, the standard display | |
5676 table if any. The display table chosen is called the @dfn{active} | |
5677 display table. | |
5678 | |
5679 @defun window-display-table &optional window | |
5680 This function returns @var{window}'s display table, or @code{nil} | |
5681 if @var{window} does not have an assigned display table. The default | |
5682 for @var{window} is the selected window. | |
5683 @end defun | |
5684 | |
5685 @defun set-window-display-table window table | |
5686 This function sets the display table of @var{window} to @var{table}. | |
5687 The argument @var{table} should be either a display table or | |
5688 @code{nil}. | |
5689 @end defun | |
5690 | |
5691 @defvar buffer-display-table | |
5692 This variable is automatically buffer-local in all buffers; its value in | |
5693 a particular buffer specifies the display table for that buffer. If it | |
5694 is @code{nil}, that means the buffer does not have an assigned display | |
5695 table. | |
5696 @end defvar | |
5697 | |
5698 @defvar standard-display-table | |
5699 This variable's value is the default display table, used whenever a | |
5700 window has no display table and neither does the buffer displayed in | |
5701 that window. This variable is @code{nil} by default. | |
5702 @end defvar | |
5703 | |
5704 If there is no display table to use for a particular window---that is, | |
5705 if the window specifies none, its buffer specifies none, and | |
5706 @code{standard-display-table} is @code{nil}---then Emacs uses the usual | |
5707 display conventions for all character codes in that window. @xref{Usual | |
5708 Display}. | |
5709 | |
5710 A number of functions for changing the standard display table | |
5711 are defined in the library @file{disp-table}. | |
5712 | |
5713 @node Glyphs | |
5714 @subsection Glyphs | |
5715 | |
5716 @cindex glyph | |
5717 A @dfn{glyph} is a generalization of a character; it stands for an | |
5718 image that takes up a single character position on the screen. Normally | |
5719 glyphs come from vectors in the display table (@pxref{Display Tables}). | |
5720 | |
5721 A glyph is represented in Lisp as a @dfn{glyph code}. A glyph code | |
5722 can be @dfn{simple} or it can be defined by the @dfn{glyph table}. A | |
5723 simple glyph code is just a way of specifying a character and a face | |
5724 to output it in. @xref{Faces}. | |
5725 | |
5726 The following functions are used to manipulate simple glyph codes: | |
5727 | |
5728 @defun make-glyph-code char &optional face | |
5729 This function returns a simple glyph code representing char @var{char} | |
5730 with face @var{face}. | |
5731 @end defun | |
5732 | |
5733 @defun glyph-char glyph | |
5734 This function returns the character of simple glyph code @var{glyph}. | |
5735 @end defun | |
5736 | |
5737 @defun glyph-face glyph | |
5738 This function returns face of simple glyph code @var{glyph}, or | |
5739 @code{nil} if @var{glyph} has the default face (face-id 0). | |
100978
d14fcdc20167
(Attribute Functions): Note that a function value :height is relative,
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100974
diff
changeset
|
5740 @xref{Face Functions}. |
84060 | 5741 @end defun |
5742 | |
5743 On character terminals, you can set up a @dfn{glyph table} to define | |
5744 the meaning of glyph codes (represented as small integers). | |
5745 | |
5746 @defvar glyph-table | |
5747 The value of this variable is the current glyph table. It should be | |
5748 @code{nil} or a vector whose @var{g}th element defines glyph code | |
5749 @var{g}. | |
5750 | |
5751 If a glyph code is greater than or equal to the length of the glyph | |
5752 table, that code is automatically simple. If @code{glyph-table} is | |
5753 @code{nil} then all glyph codes are simple. | |
5754 | |
5755 The glyph table is used only on character terminals. On graphical | |
5756 displays, all glyph codes are simple. | |
5757 @end defvar | |
5758 | |
5759 Here are the meaningful types of elements in the glyph table: | |
5760 | |
5761 @table @asis | |
5762 @item @var{string} | |
5763 Send the characters in @var{string} to the terminal to output | |
5764 this glyph code. | |
5765 | |
5766 @item @var{code} | |
5767 Define this glyph code as an alias for glyph code @var{code} created | |
5768 by @code{make-glyph-code}. You can use such an alias to define a | |
5769 small-numbered glyph code which specifies a character with a face. | |
5770 | |
5771 @item @code{nil} | |
5772 This glyph code is simple. | |
5773 @end table | |
5774 | |
5775 @defun create-glyph string | |
5776 This function returns a newly-allocated glyph code which is set up to | |
5777 display by sending @var{string} to the terminal. | |
5778 @end defun | |
5779 | |
5780 @node Beeping | |
5781 @section Beeping | |
5782 @c @cindex beeping "beep" is adjacent | |
5783 @cindex bell | |
5784 | |
5785 This section describes how to make Emacs ring the bell (or blink the | |
5786 screen) to attract the user's attention. Be conservative about how | |
5787 often you do this; frequent bells can become irritating. Also be | |
5788 careful not to use just beeping when signaling an error is more | |
5789 appropriate. (@xref{Errors}.) | |
5790 | |
5791 @defun ding &optional do-not-terminate | |
5792 @cindex keyboard macro termination | |
5793 This function beeps, or flashes the screen (see @code{visible-bell} below). | |
5794 It also terminates any keyboard macro currently executing unless | |
5795 @var{do-not-terminate} is non-@code{nil}. | |
5796 @end defun | |
5797 | |
5798 @defun beep &optional do-not-terminate | |
5799 This is a synonym for @code{ding}. | |
5800 @end defun | |
5801 | |
5802 @defopt visible-bell | |
5803 This variable determines whether Emacs should flash the screen to | |
5804 represent a bell. Non-@code{nil} means yes, @code{nil} means no. This | |
5805 is effective on graphical displays, and on text-only terminals | |
5806 provided the terminal's Termcap entry defines the visible bell | |
5807 capability (@samp{vb}). | |
5808 @end defopt | |
5809 | |
5810 @defvar ring-bell-function | |
5811 If this is non-@code{nil}, it specifies how Emacs should ``ring the | |
5812 bell.'' Its value should be a function of no arguments. If this is | |
5813 non-@code{nil}, it takes precedence over the @code{visible-bell} | |
5814 variable. | |
5815 @end defvar | |
5816 | |
5817 @node Window Systems | |
5818 @section Window Systems | |
5819 | |
5820 Emacs works with several window systems, most notably the X Window | |
5821 System. Both Emacs and X use the term ``window,'' but use it | |
5822 differently. An Emacs frame is a single window as far as X is | |
5823 concerned; the individual Emacs windows are not known to X at all. | |
5824 | |
5825 @defvar window-system | |
100597
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5826 This frame-local variable tells Lisp programs what window system Emacs is using |
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5827 for displaying the frame. The possible values are |
84060 | 5828 |
5829 @table @code | |
5830 @item x | |
5831 @cindex X Window System | |
100597
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5832 Emacs is displaying the frame using X. |
84060 | 5833 @item w32 |
100597
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5834 Emacs is displaying the frame using native MS-Windows GUI. |
103586
c78f612cb825
* display.texi (Window Systems): Add ns to the list.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103273
diff
changeset
|
5835 @item ns |
c78f612cb825
* display.texi (Window Systems): Add ns to the list.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103273
diff
changeset
|
5836 Emacs is displaying the frame using the Nextstep interface (used on |
c78f612cb825
* display.texi (Window Systems): Add ns to the list.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103273
diff
changeset
|
5837 GNUstep and Mac OS X). |
100597
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5838 @item pc |
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5839 Emacs is displaying the frame using MS-DOS direct screen writes. |
84060 | 5840 @item nil |
100597
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5841 Emacs is displaying the frame on a character-based terminal. |
84060 | 5842 @end table |
5843 @end defvar | |
5844 | |
100599
d0d51bbf9adf
(Window Systems): Document `initial-window-system'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
100597
diff
changeset
|
5845 @defvar initial-window-system |
d0d51bbf9adf
(Window Systems): Document `initial-window-system'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
100597
diff
changeset
|
5846 This variable holds the value of @code{window-system} used for the |
101443
5e2cee41c267
(Window Systems): Document the value of `initial-window-system' under --daemon.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
101289
diff
changeset
|
5847 first frame created by Emacs during startup. (When Emacs is invoked |
5e2cee41c267
(Window Systems): Document the value of `initial-window-system' under --daemon.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
101289
diff
changeset
|
5848 with the @option{--daemon} option, it does not create any initial |
5e2cee41c267
(Window Systems): Document the value of `initial-window-system' under --daemon.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
101289
diff
changeset
|
5849 frames, so @code{initial-window-system} is @code{nil}. @xref{Initial |
5e2cee41c267
(Window Systems): Document the value of `initial-window-system' under --daemon.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
101289
diff
changeset
|
5850 Options, daemon,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.) |
100599
d0d51bbf9adf
(Window Systems): Document `initial-window-system'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
100597
diff
changeset
|
5851 @end defvar |
d0d51bbf9adf
(Window Systems): Document `initial-window-system'.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
100597
diff
changeset
|
5852 |
100597
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5853 @defun window-system &optional frame |
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5854 This function returns a symbol whose name tells what window system is |
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5855 used for displaying @var{frame} (which defaults to the currently |
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5856 selected frame). The list of possible symbols it returns is the same |
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5857 one documented for the variable @code{window-system} above. |
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5858 @end defun |
849c161c893f
(Window Systems): Document `window-system' the function. The variable
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98976
diff
changeset
|
5859 |
84060 | 5860 @defvar window-setup-hook |
5861 This variable is a normal hook which Emacs runs after handling the | |
5862 initialization files. Emacs runs this hook after it has completed | |
5863 loading your init file, the default initialization file (if | |
5864 any), and the terminal-specific Lisp code, and running the hook | |
5865 @code{term-setup-hook}. | |
5866 | |
5867 This hook is used for internal purposes: setting up communication with | |
5868 the window system, and creating the initial window. Users should not | |
5869 interfere with it. | |
5870 @end defvar | |
5871 | |
5872 @ignore | |
5873 arch-tag: ffdf5714-7ecf-415b-9023-fbc6b409c2c6 | |
5874 @end ignore |